blob: c424e5ea230e8860fa995b9bce280c9d27dcbc11 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau608efa12016-10-25 22:22:00 +02007 2016/10/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100564 - wurfl-data-file
565 - wurfl-information-list
566 - wurfl-information-list-separator
567 - wurfl-engine-mode
568 - wurfl-cache-size
569 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100570
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200572 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200574 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100575 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100576 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100577 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200578 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200579 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200580 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200581 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - noepoll
583 - nokqueue
584 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100585 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300586 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000587 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200588 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200589 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200590 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - tune.buffers.limit
592 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200593 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200594 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100595 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100596 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200597 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100598 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100599 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100600 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100601 - tune.lua.session-timeout
602 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200603 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100604 - tune.maxaccept
605 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200606 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200607 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200608 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100609 - tune.rcvbuf.client
610 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100611 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100612 - tune.sndbuf.client
613 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100614 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100615 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200616 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100617 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200618 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200619 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200620 - tune.vars.global-max-size
621 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
622 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
623 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100624 - tune.zlib.memlevel
625 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 * Debugging
628 - debug
629 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630
631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006323.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633------------------------------------
634
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200635ca-base <dir>
636 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200637 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
638 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640chroot <jail dir>
641 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
642 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
643 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
644 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
645 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
646 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100647
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100648cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
649 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
650 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
651 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100652 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
653 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
654 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
655 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
656 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
657 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
658 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
659 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
660 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
661 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100662
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200663crt-base <dir>
664 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
665 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
666 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200668daemon
669 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
670 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
671 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
672
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200673deviceatlas-json-file <path>
674 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
675 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
676
677deviceatlas-log-level <value>
678 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
679 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
680
681deviceatlas-separator <char>
682 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
683 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
684
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100685deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200686 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
687 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
688 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100689
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900690external-check
691 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
692 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
693 See "option external-check".
694
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695gid <number>
696 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
697 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
698 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100699 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
700 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703group <group name>
704 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
705 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100706
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200707log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
709 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100710 configured with "log global".
711
712 <address> can be one of:
713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100714 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100715 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
716 port).
717
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100718 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
719 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
720 port).
721
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100722 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
723 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
724 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
725 writeable).
726
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200727 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
728 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100729
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200730 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
731 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
732 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
733 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
734 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
735 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
736 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
737 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
738 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
739 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
740 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
741
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200742 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
743 one of the following :
744
745 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
746 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
747
748 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
749 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
750
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100751 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752
753 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
754 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
755 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
756
757 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200758 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
759 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
760 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
761 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
762 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
763 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200765 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100767log-send-hostname [<string>]
768 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
769 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
770 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
771 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
772 the logs.
773
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000774log-tag <string>
775 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
776 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
777 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100778 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000779
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100780lua-load <file>
781 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
782 used multiple times.
783
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200784nbproc <number>
785 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
786 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
787 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
788 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
789 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
790
791pidfile <pidfile>
792 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
793 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
794 starting the process. See also "daemon".
795
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100796presetenv <name> <value>
797 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
798 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
799 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
800 and "unsetenv".
801
802resetenv [<name> ...]
803 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
804 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
805 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
806 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
807 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
808 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
809 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
810 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
811
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100812stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200813 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
814 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
815 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
816 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
817 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
818 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100819 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200820 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
821 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200822
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200823server-state-base <directory>
824 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200825 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
826 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200827
828server-state-file <file>
829 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
830 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
831 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
832 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
833 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
834 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
835 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
836 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200837 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
838 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200839
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100840setenv <name> <value>
841 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
842 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
843 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
844 and "unsetenv".
845
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100846ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
848 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300849 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100850 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
851 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
852 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
853 "bind" keyword for more information.
854
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100855ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
857 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
858 keyword to see available options.
859
860 Example:
861 global
862 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
863
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100864ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
866 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300867 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100868 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
869 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
870 information.
871
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100872ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
874 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
875 keyword to see available options.
876
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200877ssl-dh-param-file <file>
878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
879 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
880 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
881 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
882 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200883 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
884 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
885 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
886 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200887 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
888 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
889 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
890
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100891ssl-server-verify [none|required]
892 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
893 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
894 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
895
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200896stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
897 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
898 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
899 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200900 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
901 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200902
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200903 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
904 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
905 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200906
907stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
908 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
909 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100910 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200911
912stats maxconn <connections>
913 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
914 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916uid <number>
917 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
918 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
919 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
920 one. See also "gid" and "user".
921
922ulimit-n <number>
923 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
924 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
925 option.
926
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100927unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
928 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
929
930 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
931 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
932 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
933 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
934 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
935 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
936 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
937 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
938 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
939 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
940
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100941unsetenv [<name> ...]
942 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
943 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
944 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
945 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
946 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
947 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
948 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
949
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200950user <user name>
951 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
952 See also "uid" and "group".
953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200954node <name>
955 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
956
957 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
958 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
959 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
960 traffic.
961
962description <text>
963 Add a text that describes the instance.
964
965 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
966 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
967 "<" and ">" characters.
968
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096951degrees-data-file <file path>
970 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
971 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
972
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200973 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100974 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
975
97651degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
977 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
978 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
979 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
980
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200981 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100982 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
983
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020098451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100985 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
986 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
987
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200988 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
989 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
990
99151degrees-cache-size <number>
992 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
993 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
994 By default, this cache is disabled.
995
996 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100997 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
998
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100999wurfl-data-file <file path>
1000 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1001 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1002
1003 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1004 with USE_WURFL=1.
1005
1006wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1007 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1008 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1009 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1010
1011 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1012
1013 Valid WURFL properties are:
1014 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1015
1016 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1017 device.
1018
1019 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1020 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1021
1022 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1023 particular web request.
1024
1025 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1026 used Libwurfl API version.
1027
1028 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1029 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1030 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1031
1032 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1033 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1034
1035 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1036 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1037
1038 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1039
1040 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1041
1042 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1043 with USE_WURFL=1.
1044
1045wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1046 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1047 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1048
1049 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1050 with USE_WURFL=1.
1051
1052wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1053 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1054 thus before the chroot.
1055
1056 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1057 with USE_WURFL=1.
1058
1059wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1060 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1061 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1062 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1063 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1064 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1065 mode is enabled by default.
1066
1067 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1068 with USE_WURFL=1.
1069
1070wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1071 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1072 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1073 - "0" : no cache is used.
1074 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1075 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1076 the highest performing option.
1077
1078 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1079 with USE_WURFL=1.
1080
1081wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1082 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1083 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1084
1085 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1086 with USE_WURFL=1.
1087
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010893.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090-----------------------
1091
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001092max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1093 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1094 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1095 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1096 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1097 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1098 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1099 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1100 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102maxconn <number>
1103 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1104 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1105 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001106 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1107 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1108 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1109 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001110 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1111 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1112 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1113 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1114 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001116maxconnrate <number>
1117 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1118 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1119 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1120 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1121 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1122 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1123 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1124 fairness.
1125
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001126maxcomprate <number>
1127 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001128 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001129 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1130 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1131 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1132 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1133 default value.
1134
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001135maxcompcpuusage <number>
1136 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1137 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1138 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1139 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1140 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1141 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1142 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1143 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1144
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001145maxpipes <number>
1146 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1147 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1148 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1149 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1150 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1151 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1152
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001153maxsessrate <number>
1154 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1155 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1156 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1157 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1158 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1159 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1160 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1161 fairness.
1162
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001163maxsslconn <number>
1164 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1165 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1166 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1167 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1168 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1169 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1170 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001171 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1172 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1173 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1174 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1175 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1176 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1177 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001178
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001179maxsslrate <number>
1180 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1181 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1182 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1183 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1184 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1185 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1186 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1187 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1188 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1189 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1190
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001191maxzlibmem <number>
1192 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1193 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1194 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001195 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1196 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1197 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1198
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001199noepoll
1200 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1201 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001202 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203
1204nokqueue
1205 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1206 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1207 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1208
1209nopoll
1210 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1211 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001212 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001213 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001214
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001215nosplice
1216 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1217 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1218 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001219 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001220 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1221 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1222 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1223 "option splice-response".
1224
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001225nogetaddrinfo
1226 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1227 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1228
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001229noreuseport
1230 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1231 command line argument "-dR".
1232
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001233spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001234 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1235 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1236 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1237 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1238 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1239 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001240
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001241tune.buffers.limit <number>
1242 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1243 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1244 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1245 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1246 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1247 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1248 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1249 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1250 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1251 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1252 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1253 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1254 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1255 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1256 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1257
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001258tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1259 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1260 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1261 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1262 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1263
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001264tune.bufsize <number>
1265 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1266 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1267 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1268 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1269 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1270 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1271 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1272 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001273 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1274 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1275 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001276
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001277tune.chksize <number>
1278 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1279 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1280 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1281 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1282 checks whenever possible.
1283
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001284tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1285 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1286 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1287 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1288 this value. The default value is 1.
1289
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001290tune.http.cookielen <number>
1291 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1292 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1293 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1294 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1295 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1296 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1297 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1298 to change this value.
1299
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001300tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1301 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1302 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1303 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1304 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1305 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1306 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1307 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1308 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1309 limit too high.
1310
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001311tune.idletimer <timeout>
1312 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1313 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1314 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1315 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1316 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1317 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1318 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1319 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1320 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1321
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001322tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1323 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1324 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1325 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1326 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1327 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1328 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1329 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1330
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001331tune.lua.maxmem
1332 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1333 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1334 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1335 memory.
1336
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001337tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1338 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001339 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1340 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1341 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001342
1343tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1344 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1345 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1346 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1347 check servers.
1348
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001349tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1350 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1351 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1352 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1353 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1354
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001355tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001356 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1357 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1358 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1359 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1360 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1361 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1362 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1363 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1364 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1365 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001366
1367tune.maxpollevents <number>
1368 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1369 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1370 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1371 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1372 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1373
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001374tune.maxrewrite <number>
1375 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1376 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1377 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1378 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1379 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1380 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1381 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1382 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1383 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1384 bufsize.
1385
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001386tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1387 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1388 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1389 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1390 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1391 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1392 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1393 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1394 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1395 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1396 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1397 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1398 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1399 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1400 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1401 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1402 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1403 setting this parameter to 0.
1404
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001405tune.pipesize <number>
1406 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1407 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1408 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1409 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1410 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1411 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1412
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001413tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1414tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1415 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1416 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1417 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1418 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1419 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1420 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1421 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1422
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001423tune.recv_enough <number>
1424 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1425 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1426 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1427 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1428 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1429
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001430tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1431tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1432 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1433 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1434 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1435 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1436 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1437 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1438 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1439 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1440 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1441 notifying haproxy again.
1442
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001443tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001444 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1445 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1446 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001447 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001448 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1449 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1450 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1451 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1452 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001453 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1454 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001455
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001456tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1457 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1458 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1459 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1460 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1461 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1462 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1463
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001464tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1465 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001466 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001467 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1468 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1469 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1470 being used for too long.
1471
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001472tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1473 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1474 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1475 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1476 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1477 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1478 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1479 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1480 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1481 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1482 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001483 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1484 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001485
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001486tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1487 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1488 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1489 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1490 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1491 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1492 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1493 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001494 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1495 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001496
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001497tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1498 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1499 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1500 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1501 1000 entries.
1502
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001503tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1504tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1505tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1506tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001507 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1508 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1509 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1510 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1511 response processing.
1512 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1513 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1514 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001515
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001516 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1517 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1518 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1519 all available space is consumed.
1520 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1521 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1522 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001523
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001524tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1525 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001526 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001527 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1528 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1529 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1530
1531tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1532 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1533 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1534 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1535 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015373.3. Debugging
1538--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001539
1540debug
1541 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1542 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1543 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1544 system startup.
1545
1546quiet
1547 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1548 line argument "-q".
1549
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015513.4. Userlists
1552--------------
1553It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1554http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1555it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1556
1557userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001558 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001559 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1560
1561group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001562 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001563 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1564 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1565
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001566user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1567 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001568 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1569 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001570 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1571 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001572 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001573 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001574
1575
1576 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001577 userlist L1
1578 group G1 users tiger,scott
1579 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001580
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001581 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1582 user scott insecure-password elgato
1583 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001584
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001585 userlist L2
1586 group G1
1587 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001588
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001589 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1590 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1591 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001592
1593 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001594
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001595
15963.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001597----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001598It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1599several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1600instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1601values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1602automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1603In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1604using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1605tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1606reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1607Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1608that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1609each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001610
1611peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001612 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001613 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1614
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001615disabled
1616 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1617 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1618 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1619
1620enable
1621 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1622
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001623peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1624 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1625 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1626 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1627 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1628 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1629 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1630
1631 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1632 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1633
1634 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1635 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1636 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1637 across all peers.
1638
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001639 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1640 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001641
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001642 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001643 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001644 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1645 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1646 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001647
1648 backend mybackend
1649 mode tcp
1650 balance roundrobin
1651 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1652 stick on src
1653
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001654 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1655 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656
1657
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016583.6. Mailers
1659------------
1660It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1661If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1662in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1663
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001664mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001665 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1666 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1667
1668mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1669 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1670
1671 Example:
1672 mailers mymailers
1673 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1674 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1675
1676 backend mybackend
1677 mode tcp
1678 balance roundrobin
1679
1680 email-alert mailers mymailers
1681 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1682 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1683
1684 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1685 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1686
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001687timeout mail <time>
1688 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1689 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1690 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1691 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1692
1693 Example:
1694 mailers mymailers
1695 timeout mail 20s
1696 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001699----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001702 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001703 - frontend <name>
1704 - backend <name>
1705 - listen <name>
1706
1707A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1708its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1709section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001710section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001711
1712A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1713connections.
1714
1715A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1716to forward incoming connections.
1717
1718A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1719parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1722'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1723case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1724
1725Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1726logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1727proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1728However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1729name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1730
1731Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1732and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001733bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1735modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1736arbitrary criteria.
1737
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001738In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1739a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1740the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1741
1742 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1743 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1744 between responses and new requests.
1745
1746 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1747 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1748 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1749 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1750
1751 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1752 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1753 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1754
1755 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1756 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1757 client-facing connection remains open.
1758
1759 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1760 after the end of the response.
1761
1762The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1763frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1764following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1765weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1766
1767 Backend mode
1768
1769 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1770 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1771 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1772 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1773 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1774 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1775 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1776 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1777 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1778 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1779 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1784--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001786The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1787limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1788they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1789limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001790marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001791option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001792and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1793with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1794specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001796
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001797 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1798------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1799acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001800appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001801backlog X X X -
1802balance X - X X
1803bind - X X -
1804bind-process X X X X
1805block - X X X
1806capture cookie - X X -
1807capture request header - X X -
1808capture response header - X X -
1809clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001810compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001811contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1812cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001813declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814default-server X - X X
1815default_backend X X X -
1816description - X X X
1817disabled X X X X
1818dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001819email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001820email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001821email-alert mailers X X X X
1822email-alert myhostname X X X X
1823email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001824enabled X X X X
1825errorfile X X X X
1826errorloc X X X X
1827errorloc302 X X X X
1828-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1829errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001830force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001831filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832fullconn X - X X
1833grace X X X X
1834hash-type X - X X
1835http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001836http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001837http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001838http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001839http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001840http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001841http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001842id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001843ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001844load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001845log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001846log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001847log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001848log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001849max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001850maxconn X X X -
1851mode X X X X
1852monitor fail - X X -
1853monitor-net X X X -
1854monitor-uri X X X -
1855option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1856option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1857option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1858option allbackups (*) X - X X
1859option checkcache (*) X - X X
1860option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1861option contstats (*) X X X -
1862option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1863option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1864option forceclose (*) X X X X
1865-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1866option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001867option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001868option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001869option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001870option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001871option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001872option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001873option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001874option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1875option httpchk X - X X
1876option httpclose (*) X X X X
1877option httplog X X X X
1878option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001879option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001880option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001881option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001882option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1883option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1884option logasap (*) X X X -
1885option mysql-check X - X X
1886option nolinger (*) X X X X
1887option originalto X X X X
1888option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001889option pgsql-check X - X X
1890option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001892option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001893option smtpchk X - X X
1894option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1895option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1896option splice-request (*) X X X X
1897option splice-response (*) X X X X
1898option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1899option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1900-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001901option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001902option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1903option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1904option tcpka X X X X
1905option tcplog X X X X
1906option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001907external-check command X - X X
1908external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001909persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1910rate-limit sessions X X X -
1911redirect - X X X
1912redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1913redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1914reqadd - X X X
1915reqallow - X X X
1916reqdel - X X X
1917reqdeny - X X X
1918reqiallow - X X X
1919reqidel - X X X
1920reqideny - X X X
1921reqipass - X X X
1922reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001923reqitarpit - X X X
1924reqpass - X X X
1925reqrep - X X X
1926-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001927reqtarpit - X X X
1928retries X - X X
1929rspadd - X X X
1930rspdel - X X X
1931rspdeny - X X X
1932rspidel - X X X
1933rspideny - X X X
1934rspirep - X X X
1935rsprep - X X X
1936server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001937server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001938source X - X X
1939srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001940stats admin - X X X
1941stats auth X X X X
1942stats enable X X X X
1943stats hide-version X X X X
1944stats http-request - X X X
1945stats realm X X X X
1946stats refresh X X X X
1947stats scope X X X X
1948stats show-desc X X X X
1949stats show-legends X X X X
1950stats show-node X X X X
1951stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001952-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1953stick match - - X X
1954stick on - - X X
1955stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001956stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001957stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001958tcp-check connect - - X X
1959tcp-check expect - - X X
1960tcp-check send - - X X
1961tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001962tcp-request connection - X X -
1963tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001964tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001965tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001966tcp-response content - - X X
1967tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001968timeout check X - X X
1969timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001970timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001971timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1972timeout connect X - X X
1973timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1974timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1975timeout http-request X X X X
1976timeout queue X - X X
1977timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001978timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1980timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001981timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001982transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001983unique-id-format X X X -
1984unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001985use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001986use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001987------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1988 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1992---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1995
1996
1997acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1998 Declare or complete an access list.
1999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2000 no | yes | yes | yes
2001 Example:
2002 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2003 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2004 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002006 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
2008
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002009appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2010 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | no | yes | yes
2014 Arguments :
2015 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2016 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2017
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002018 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 checked in each cookie value.
2020
2021 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2022 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2023 milliseconds.
2024
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002025 request-learn
2026 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2027 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2028 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2029 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2030 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2031 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2032
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002033 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2034 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2035 data following this prefix.
2036
2037 Example :
2038 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2039
2040 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2041 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2042
2043 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2044 2 modes are currently supported :
2045 - path-parameters :
2046 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2047 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2048 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2049 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2050 - query-string :
2051 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2052 query string.
2053
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002054 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2055 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2056 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002058 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2059 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
2061
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002062backlog <conns>
2063 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2065 yes | yes | yes | no
2066 Arguments :
2067 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2068 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002069 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002070
2071 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2072 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2073 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2074 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2075 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2076 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2077 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2078 backlog parameter.
2079
2080 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2081 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2082 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2083
2084 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2085
2086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002088balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2091 yes | no | yes | yes
2092 Arguments :
2093 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2094 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2095 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2096 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2097
2098 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2099 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2100 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2101 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002102 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002103 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002104 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2105 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2106 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2107 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2108 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2109 it, so that you don't worry.
2110
2111 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2112 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2113 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2114 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2115 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2116 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2117 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2118 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002120 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2121 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2122 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2123 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2124 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2125 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2126 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2127 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2128
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002129 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002130 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002131 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2132 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002133 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002134 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2135 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2136 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2137 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2138 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002139 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2140 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2141 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2142 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2143 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2144 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2147 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2148 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2149 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2150 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2151 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2152 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2153 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002154 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002156 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2157 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2158 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002160 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2161 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2162 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2163 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2164 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2165 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2166 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2167 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2168 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2169 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2170 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2171 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002173 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002174 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2175 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2176 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2177 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2178 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2179 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2180 URIs start with a leading "/".
2181
2182 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2183 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2184 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2185 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002188 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2189
2190 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002191 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2192 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002193 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2194 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2195 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2196 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002197 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002198 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2199 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002200
2201 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2202 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2203 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2204 server will receive the request.
2205
2206 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2207 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2208 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2209 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2210 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002211 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2212 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2213 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002215 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2216 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2217 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2218 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2219 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002221 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002222 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2223 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2224 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2225
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002226 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2227 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2228 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2229
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002230 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002231 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002232 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2233 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2234 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2235 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2236 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2237 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002238 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002239 used instead.
2240
2241 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2242 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2243 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2244 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2245
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002246 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2247 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2248 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2249
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002250 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002252 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002253 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2254 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002255
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002256 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2257 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2258 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
2260 Examples :
2261 balance roundrobin
2262 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002263 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002264 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2265 balance hdr(host)
2266 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002267
2268 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2269 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002271 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002272 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2273 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2274 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2275 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2276
2277 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2278 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2279 defaults to 16 kB.
2280
2281 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2282 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2283
2284 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2285 Round Robin.
2286
2287 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2288 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2289 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2290 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2291
2292 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2293
2294 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002295 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002296 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2297 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2298 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002300 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002301
2302
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002303bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2304bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2307 no | yes | yes | no
2308 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002309 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2310 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2311 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2312 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002313 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002314 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2315 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2316 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2317 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2318 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2319 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2320 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002321 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2322 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2323 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2324 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2325 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2326 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2327 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002328 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2329 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2330 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002331 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2332 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2333 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002334
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002335 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2336 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002337 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2338 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2339 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002340 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2341 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2342 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2343 the range.
2344
2345 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2346 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2347 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2348 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2349 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2350 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2351 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002352 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002353 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002354
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002355 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2356 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2357 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2358 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2359 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2360 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2361 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2362 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2363
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002364 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2365 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2366 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2367 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2370 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2371 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2372 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2373 in a frontend.
2374
2375 Example :
2376 listen http_proxy
2377 bind :80,:443
2378 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002379 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002381 listen http_https_proxy
2382 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002383 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002384
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002385 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2386 bind ipv6@:80
2387 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2388 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2389
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002390 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002391 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002392
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002393 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2394 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2395 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2396 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2397 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2398
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002399 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002400 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401
2402
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002403bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002404 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2406 yes | yes | yes | yes
2407 Arguments :
2408 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2409 may be used to override a default value.
2410
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002411 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002412 option may be combined with other numbers.
2413
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002414 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002415 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2416 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2417 missing from all processes.
2418
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002419 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002420 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002421 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2422 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2423 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2424 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002425
2426 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2427 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2428 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2429 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2430 and 'even' instances.
2431
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002432 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2433 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2434 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2435 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002436
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002437 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2438 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2439
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002440 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2441 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2442 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2443
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002444 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2445 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2446
2447 Example :
2448 listen app_ip1
2449 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002450 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002451
2452 listen app_ip2
2453 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002454 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002455
2456 listen management
2457 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002458 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002459
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002460 listen management
2461 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2462 bind-process 1-4
2463
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002464 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002465
2466
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467block { if | unless } <condition>
2468 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2470 no | yes | yes | yes
2471
2472 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2473 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002474 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002475 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2477 "block" statements per instance.
2478
2479 Example:
2480 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2481 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2482 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2483 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002485 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486
2487
2488capture cookie <name> len <length>
2489 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2491 no | yes | yes | no
2492 Arguments :
2493 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2494 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2495 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2496 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2497 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2498
2499 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2500 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2501 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2502 right if it exceeds <length>.
2503
2504 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2505 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2506 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2507 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2508
2509 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2510 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2511 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2512
2513 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2514 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2515 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002516 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2517 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2518 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519
2520 Example:
2521 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2522
2523 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002524 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002525
2526
2527capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002528 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2530 no | yes | yes | no
2531 Arguments :
2532 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002533 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2535 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2536 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2537
2538 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2539 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2540 it exceeds <length>.
2541
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002542 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2544 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002545 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2546 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2547 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2548 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002549 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002550 environments to find where the request came from.
2551
2552 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2553 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2554 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2555 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002557 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2558 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2559 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2560 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2561 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562
2563 Example:
2564 capture request header Host len 15
2565 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002566 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002568 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569 about logging.
2570
2571
2572capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002573 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2575 no | yes | yes | no
2576 Arguments :
2577 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002578 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2580 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2581 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2582
2583 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2584 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2585 it exceeds <length>.
2586
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002587 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2589 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2590 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002591 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2592 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2593 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2594 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002595
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002596 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2597 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2598 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2599 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2600 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601
2602 Example:
2603 capture response header Content-length len 9
2604 capture response header Location len 15
2605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002606 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607 about logging.
2608
2609
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002610clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2617 as explained at the top of this document.
2618
2619 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2620 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2621 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2622 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2623 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2624 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2625 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2626 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002627 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2629 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2630
2631 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2632 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2633 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2634 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2635 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2636 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2637
2638 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2639 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2640
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002641 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2642 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002644compression algo <algorithm> ...
2645compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002646compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002647 Enable HTTP compression.
2648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 yes | yes | yes | yes
2650 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002651 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2652 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2653 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2654
2655 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002656 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2657 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2658 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002659
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002660 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002661 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002662
2663 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2664 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2665 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2666 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2667 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002668 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002669
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002670 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2671 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2672 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2673 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2674 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2675 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2676 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002677 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002678
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002679 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002680 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002681 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2682 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2683 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2684 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2685 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002686
2687 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2688 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2689 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2690 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2691 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002692 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2693 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2694 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2695 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2696 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002697 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2698 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002699
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002700 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002701 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2702 "Accept-Encoding" header
2703 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002704 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002705 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2706 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002707 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2708 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2709 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2710 "multipart"
2711 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2712 header
2713 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2714 and later
2715 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2716 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002717
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002718 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2719 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002720
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002721 Examples :
2722 compression algo gzip
2723 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002725
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002726contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2729 yes | no | yes | yes
2730 Arguments :
2731 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2733 as explained at the top of this document.
2734
2735 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002736 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002737 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2739 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2740 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2741 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2742
2743 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2744 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2745 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2746 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2747 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2748 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2749
2750 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2751 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2752 instead.
2753
2754 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2755 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2756
2757
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002758cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002759 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2760 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2763 yes | no | yes | yes
2764 Arguments :
2765 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2766 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2767 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2768 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2769 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2770 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2771 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2772 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2773 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2774
2775 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2776 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2777 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2778 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2779 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2780 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002781 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2782 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2783 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2784 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2785 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786
2787 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002788 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002789
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002790 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002791 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2792 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2793 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2794 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2795 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2796 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2797 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2798 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2799 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2800 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002801
2802 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2803 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2804 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2805 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2806 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2807 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2808 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2809 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2810 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002811 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002812 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2813 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2814 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002816 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2817 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2818 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002819 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2820 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2821 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2822 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002823 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2824 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2825 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826
2827 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2828 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2829 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2830 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2831 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2832 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2833 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2834 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2835 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2836
2837 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2838 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2839 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2840 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2841 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2842 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2843 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2844 persistence cookie in the cache.
2845 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2846
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002847 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2848 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2849 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2850 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2851 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2852 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2853 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2854 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2855 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2856 they logout.
2857
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002858 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2859 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2860 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2861 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2862
2863 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2864 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2865 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2866 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2867 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2868 this attribute.
2869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002870 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002871 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002872 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2873 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2874 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2875 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2876 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2877 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002878
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002879 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2880 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2881 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2882 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2883 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2884 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2885 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2886 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2887 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2888 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2889 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2890 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2891 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2892 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2893 the site.
2894
2895 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2896 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2897 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2898 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2899 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2900 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2901 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2902 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2903 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2904 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2905 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2906 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2907 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2908 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2909 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2910 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2913 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2914 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2915 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 Examples :
2918 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2919 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2920 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002921 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002923 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002925
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002926declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2927 Declares a capture slot.
2928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2929 no | yes | yes | no
2930 Arguments:
2931 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2932
2933 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2934 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2935 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2936 for use in the response.
2937
2938 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002939 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002940 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2941
2942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002943default-server [param*]
2944 Change default options for a server in a backend
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | no | yes | yes
2947 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002948 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2949 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2950 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2951 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002952
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002953 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002954 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2955
2956 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959default_backend <backend>
2960 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2962 yes | yes | yes | no
2963 Arguments :
2964 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2965
2966 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2967 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2968 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2969 will catch all undetermined requests.
2970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971 Example :
2972
2973 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2974 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2975 default_backend dynamic
2976
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002977 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002980description <string>
2981 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 no | yes | yes | yes
2984 Arguments : string
2985
2986 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2987 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2988 it describes.
2989 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2990
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992disabled
2993 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
2996 Arguments : none
2997
2998 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2999 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3000 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3001 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3002 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3003 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3004 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3005
3006 See also : "enabled"
3007
3008
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003009dispatch <address>:<port>
3010 Set a default server address
3011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3012 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003014
3015 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3016 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3017 during start-up.
3018
3019 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3020 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3021 possible with normal servers.
3022
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003023 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003024 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3025 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3026 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3027 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3028
3029 See also : "server"
3030
3031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032enabled
3033 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 yes | yes | yes | yes
3036 Arguments : none
3037
3038 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3039 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3040
3041 See also : "disabled"
3042
3043
3044errorfile <code> <file>
3045 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3047 yes | yes | yes | yes
3048 Arguments :
3049 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003050 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3051 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003052
3053 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003054 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003056 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3057 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058
3059 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3060 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3061 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3062
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003063 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3066 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3067 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3068 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3069
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003070 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3071 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3072 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3073 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3074 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3075 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3078 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3079 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003080 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3082
3083 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3084
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003085 Example :
3086 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003087 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003088 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3089 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3090
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003091
3092errorloc <code> <url>
3093errorloc302 <code> <url>
3094 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3096 yes | yes | yes | yes
3097 Arguments :
3098 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003099 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003100
3101 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3102 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3103 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3104 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3105 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3106
3107 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3108 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3109 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3110
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003111 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3112
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003113 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3114 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3115 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3116 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003117 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003118 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3119 request.
3120
3121 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3122
3123
3124errorloc303 <code> <url>
3125 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | yes
3128 Arguments :
3129 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3130 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3131
3132 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3133 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3134 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3135 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3136 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3137
3138 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3139 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3140 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3141
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003142 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3143
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003144 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3145 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3146 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3147 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003148 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003149
3150 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3151
3152
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003153email-alert from <emailaddr>
3154 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3155 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3157 yes | yes | yes | yes
3158
3159 Arguments :
3160
3161 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3162
3163 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3164 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3165
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003166 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003167 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3168 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003169
3170
3171email-alert level <level>
3172 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3173 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3175 yes | yes | yes | yes
3176
3177 Arguments :
3178
3179 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3180 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3181 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3182
3183 By default level is alert
3184
3185 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3186 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3187 for the proxy.
3188
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003189 Alerts are sent when :
3190
3191 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3192 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3193 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3194 is notice or lower
3195 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3196 and a health check status update occurs
3197
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003198 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3199 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003200 section 3.6 about mailers.
3201
3202
3203email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3204 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3206 yes | yes | yes | yes
3207
3208 Arguments :
3209
3210 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3211
3212 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3213 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3214
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003215 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3216 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003217
3218
3219email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3220 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3221 mailers.
3222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3223 yes | yes | yes | yes
3224
3225 Arguments :
3226
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003227 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003228
3229 By default the systems hostname is used.
3230
3231 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3232 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3233 for the proxy.
3234
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003235 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3236 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003237
3238
3239email-alert to <emailaddr>
3240 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3241 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | yes
3244
3245 Arguments :
3246
3247 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3248
3249 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3250 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3251
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003252 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003253 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3254
3255
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003256force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3257 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 no | yes | yes | yes
3260
3261 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3262 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3263 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3264 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3265 marked down for maintenance operations.
3266
3267 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3268 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3269 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3270 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3271 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3272 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3273 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3274 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3275 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3276
3277 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3278 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3279 is used.
3280
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003281 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003282 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003283
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003284
3285filter <name> [param*]
3286 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 no | yes | yes | yes
3289 Arguments :
3290 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3291 referenced in section 9.
3292
3293 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3294 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3295 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3296 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3297
3298 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3299 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3300
3301 Example:
3302 listen
3303 bind *:80
3304
3305 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3306 filter compression
3307 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3308
3309 compression algo gzip
3310 compression offload
3311
3312 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3313
3314 See also : section 9.
3315
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003316
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003317fullconn <conns>
3318 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3320 yes | no | yes | yes
3321 Arguments :
3322 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3323 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3324
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003325 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003326 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003327 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003328 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3329 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3330 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3331 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3332 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003333 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003334
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003335 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3336 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003337 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3338 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3339 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003340
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003341 Example :
3342 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3343 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3344 # connections.
3345 backend dynamic
3346 fullconn 10000
3347 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3348 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3349
3350 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3351
3352
3353grace <time>
3354 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003357 Arguments :
3358 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3359 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3360 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3361
3362 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3363 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003364 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003365 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3366
3367 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3368 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3369 simplify it.
3370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003372hash-balance-factor <factor>
3373 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 yes | no | no | yes
3376 Arguments :
3377 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3378 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3379 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3380
3381 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3382 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3383 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3384 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3385 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3386 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3387 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3388
3389 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3390 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3391 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3392 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3393 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3394
3395 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3396
3397
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003398hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003399 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | no | yes | yes
3402 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003403 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3404 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003405
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003406 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3407 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3408 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3409 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3410 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3411 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3412 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3413 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3414 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3415 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003416
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003417 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3418 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3419 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3420 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3421 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3422 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3423 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3424 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3425 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3426 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3427 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3428 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3429 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003430 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3431 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003432
3433 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3434
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003435 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003436 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3437 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3438 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003439 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3440 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3441 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003442
3443 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3444 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003445 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3446 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3447 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3448 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3449
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003450 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3451 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3452 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3453 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3454 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3455 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3456 parameter.
3457
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003458 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3459 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3460 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3461 used on strings.
3462
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003463 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3464
3465 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3466 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3467 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3468 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3469 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3470 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3471 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3472 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3473 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3474 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3475 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3476 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003477
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003478 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3479 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3480 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003481
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003482 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003483
3484
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485http-check disable-on-404
3486 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489 Arguments : none
3490
3491 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3492 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3493 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3494 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3495 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3496 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3497 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3498 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003499 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3500 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3501 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3502
3503 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3504
3505
3506http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003507 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003509 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003510 Arguments :
3511 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3512 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003513 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003514 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3515 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3516 details on the supported keywords.
3517
3518 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3519 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3520 with the usual backslash ('\').
3521
3522 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3523 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3524 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3525 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3526 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3527
3528 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003529 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003530 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3531 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3532 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3533
3534 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003535 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003536 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3537 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3538 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3539 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3540
3541 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003543 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3544 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3545 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3546 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3547 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3548 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3549 trace).
3550
3551 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003552 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003553 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3554 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3555 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3556 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3557 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3558 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3559
3560 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3561 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3562 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3563 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3564 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3565 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3566 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3567 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3568
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003569 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3570 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3571 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3572
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003573 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3574 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3575
3576 Examples :
3577 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003578 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003579
3580 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003581 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003582
3583 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003584 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003585
3586 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003587 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003588
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003589 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003590
3591
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003592http-check send-state
3593 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3595 yes | no | yes | yes
3596 Arguments : none
3597
3598 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3599 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3600 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3601 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3602 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3603
3604 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3605 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3606 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3607 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3608 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003609 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3610 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3611 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3612
3613 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3614 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3615 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3616
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003617 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3618 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3619 checked in multiple backends.
3620
3621 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3622 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3623
3624 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3625 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3626 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3627 one fails.
3628
3629 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3630 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3631 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3632
3633 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3634 server's queue.
3635
3636 Example of a header received by the application server :
3637 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3638 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3639
3640 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3641
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003642http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3643 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003644 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003645 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003646 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003647 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3648 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003649 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3650 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003651 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3652 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3653 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003654 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003655 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003656 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003657 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003658 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003659 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003660 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003661 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003662 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3663
3664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 no | yes | yes | yes
3666
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003667 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3668 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3669 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3670 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3671 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003672
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003673 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3674 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3675 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3676
3677 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003678 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3679 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3680 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3681 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003682
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003683 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3684 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3685 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3686 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3687 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3688 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3689 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3690 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3691 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003692 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003693 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3694 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003695
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003696 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3697 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3698 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3699 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3700 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3701
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003702 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3703 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3704 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003705 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3706 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003707
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003708 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3709 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3710 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3711 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3712 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3713 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3714 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3715 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3716
3717 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3718 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3719 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003720 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3721 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003722
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003723 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3724 <name>.
3725
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003726 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3727 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3728 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3729 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3730 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3731 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3732 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3733 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3734
3735 Example:
3736
3737 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3738
3739 applied to:
3740
3741 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3742
3743 outputs:
3744
3745 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3746
3747 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3748
3749 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3750 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3751 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3752 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3753 header.
3754
3755 Example:
3756
3757 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3758
3759 applied to:
3760
3761 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3762
3763 outputs:
3764
3765 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3766
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003767 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3768 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3769 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3770 it.
3771
3772 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3773 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3774 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3775 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3776 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3777 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3778
3779 Example :
3780 # prepend the host name before the path
3781 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3782
3783 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3784 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3785 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3786 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3787 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3788 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3789 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3790 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3791
3792 Example :
3793 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3794 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3795
3796 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3797 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3798 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3799 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3800 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3801 "set-query".
3802
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003803 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3804 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3805 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3806 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3807 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3808 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3809 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3810 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3811
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003812 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3813 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3814 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3815 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3816 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3817 another equipment.
3818
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003819 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3820 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3821 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3822 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3823 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3824 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3825 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3826 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3827
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003828 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3829 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3830 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3831 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3832 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3833 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3834 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3835 admin privileges.
3836
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003837 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3838 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3839 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3840 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3841 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3842 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3843 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3844 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3845
3846 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3847 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3848 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3849 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3850 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3851 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3852
3853 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3854 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3855 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3856 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3857 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3858 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3859
3860 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3861 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3862 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3863 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3864 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3865 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3866 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3867 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3868 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3869
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003870 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003871 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3872 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3873 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3874 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3875 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3876 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3877 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3878 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3879 request header" for more information.
3880
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003881 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3882 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3883 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3884 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003885 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3886 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003887
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003888 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3889 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3890 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3891 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3892 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3893 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3894 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3895 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3896 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3897 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3898 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3899 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3900
3901 These actions take one or two arguments :
3902 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3903 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3904 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3905 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3906
3907 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3908 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3909 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3910 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3911
3912 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3913 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3914 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3915 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3916 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3917 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3918 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3919 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3920
3921 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3922 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3923 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3924 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3925 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3926
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003927 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3928 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3929 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3930 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3931 continues.
3932
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003933 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3934 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3935 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3936 the actions evaluation continues.
3937
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003938 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3939 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3940 inline.
3941
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003942 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3943 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3944 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3945 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003946 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003947 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003948 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003949 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3950 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003952 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003953 and '_'.
3954
3955 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3956 followed by some converters.
3957
3958 Example:
3959
3960 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3961
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003962 - set-src <expr> :
3963 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3964 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3965 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3966 source IP for privacy.
3967
3968 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3969 followed by some converters.
3970
3971 Example:
3972
3973 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3974 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3975
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003976 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
3977 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003978
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003979 - set-src-port <expr> :
3980 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3981 expression.
3982
3983 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3984 followed by some converters.
3985
3986 Example:
3987
3988 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3989 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3990
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003991 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
3992 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
3993 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003994
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003995 - set-dst <expr> :
3996 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3997 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3998 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3999 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4000 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4001
4002 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4003 followed by some converters.
4004
4005 Example:
4006
4007 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4008 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4009
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004010 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4011 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4012
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004013 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4014 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4015 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4016 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4017
4018 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4019 followed by some converters.
4020
4021 Example:
4022
4023 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4024 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4025
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004026 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4027 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4028 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4029
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004030 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4031 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4032 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4033 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4034 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4035 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4036 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4037 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4038 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4039 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4040 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4041 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4042 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4043 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4044 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4045 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4046
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004047 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4048
4049 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4050 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004051 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4052 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4053
4054 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4055 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4056 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4057 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004058
4059 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004060 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4061 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4062 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004063
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004064 http-request allow if nagios
4065 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4066 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4067 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004068
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004069 Example:
4070 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004071 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004072
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004073 Example:
4074 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4075 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004076 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004077 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4078 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4079 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4080 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4081 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4082 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4083
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004084 Example:
4085 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4086 acl add path /addacl
4087 acl del path /delacl
4088
4089 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4090
4091 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4092 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4093
4094 Example:
4095 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4096 acl setmap path /setmap
4097 acl delmap path /delmap
4098
4099 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4100
4101 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4102 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4103
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004104 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4105 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004106
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004107http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004108 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004109 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004110 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4111 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004112 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004113 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4114 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4115 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4116 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004117 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004118 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004119 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004120 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004121 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004122 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004123 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004124 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004125 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4126
4127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4128 no | yes | yes | yes
4129
4130 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4131 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4132 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4133 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4134 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4135 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4136
4137 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4138 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4139 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4140 current section.
4141
4142 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4143 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4144 rules are evaluated.
4145
4146 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4147 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4148 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4149 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4150 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4151 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4152 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4153
4154 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4155 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4156 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4157 external users.
4158
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004159 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4160 <name>.
4161
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004162 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4163 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4164 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4165 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4166 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4167 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4168 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4169 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4170
4171 Example:
4172
4173 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4174
4175 applied to:
4176
4177 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4178
4179 outputs:
4180
4181 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4182
4183 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4184
4185 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4186 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4187 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4188 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4189 header.
4190
4191 Example:
4192
4193 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4194
4195 applied to:
4196
4197 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4198
4199 outputs:
4200
4201 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4202
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004203 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4204 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4205 adapted to the new code.
4206
4207 Example:
4208
4209 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4210 http-response set-status 431
4211
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004212 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4213 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4214 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4215 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4216 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4217 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4218 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4219 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4220
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004221 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4222 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4223 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4224 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4225 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4226 another equipment.
4227
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004228 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4229 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4230 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4231 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4232 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4233 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4234 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4235 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4236
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004237 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4238 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4239 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4240 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4241 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4242 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4243 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4244 admin privileges.
4245
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004246 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4247 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4248 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4249 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4250 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4251 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4252 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4253 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4254
4255 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4256 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4257 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4258 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4259 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4260 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4261
4262 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4263 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4264 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4265 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4266 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4267 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4268
4269 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4270 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4271 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4272 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4273 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4274 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4275 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4276 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4277 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4278
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004279 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4280 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4281 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4282 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4283 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4284 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4285 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4286 response header" for more information.
4287
4288 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4289 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4290 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4291 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4292 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004293 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4294 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004295
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004296 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4297 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4298 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4299 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4300 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4301 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4302
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004303 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4304 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4305 inline.
4306
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004307 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4308 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4310 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004311 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004312 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004313 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004314 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4315 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004317 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004318 and '_'.
4319
4320 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4321 followed by some converters.
4322
4323 Example:
4324
4325 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4326
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004327 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4328 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4329 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4330 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4331 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4332 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4333 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4334
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004335 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4336 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4337 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4338 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4339 continues.
4340
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004341 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4342 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4343 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4344 the actions evaluation continues.
4345
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004346 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4347 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4348 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4349 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4350 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4351 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4352 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4353 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4354 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4355 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4356 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4357 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4358 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4359 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4360 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4361 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4362
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004363 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4364
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004365 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004366 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4367 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004368 rules.
4369
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004370 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4371 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4372 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4373 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4374
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004375 Example:
4376 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4377
4378 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4379
4380 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4381 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4382
4383 Example:
4384 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4385
4386 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4387
4388 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4389 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4390
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004391 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4392 ACL usage.
4393
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004394
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004395http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4396 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4397
4398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400
4401 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4402 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4403 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4404 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4405 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4406 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4407
4408 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4409
4410 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4411 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4412 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4413 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4414 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4415 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4416 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4417 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4418 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4419 not checking any request past the first one.
4420
4421 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4422 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4423 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4424 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4425 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4426 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4427 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4428
4429 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4430 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4431 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4432 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4433 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4434 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4435 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4436 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4437 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4438 downsides of rare connection failures.
4439
4440 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4441 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4442 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4443 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4444 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4445 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4446 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4447 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4448 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4449 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4450 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4451 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4452
4453 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4454 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4455 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4456 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4457
4458 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4459 and are never shared ;
4460
4461 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4462 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4463 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4464 and are never shared ;
4465
4466 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4467 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4468 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4469
4470 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4471 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4472 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4473
4474 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4475
4476
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004477http-send-name-header [<header>]
4478 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4479
4480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | no | yes | yes
4482
4483 Arguments :
4484
4485 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4486
4487 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4488 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4489 is added with the header string proved.
4490
4491 See also : "server"
4492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004493id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004494 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4496 no | yes | yes | yes
4497 Arguments : none
4498
4499 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4500 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4501 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004502
4503
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004504ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4505 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 no | yes | yes | yes
4508
4509 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4510 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4511 and running).
4512
4513 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4514 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4515 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004516 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004517 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4518
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004519 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4520 "unless" condition is met.
4521
4522 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4523
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004524load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4525 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 yes | no | yes | yes
4528
4529 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4530 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4531 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4532 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4533 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4534 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4535 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4536 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4537
4538 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4539 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004540 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004541
4542 Arguments:
4543 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4544 named "server-state-file".
4545
4546 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4547 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4548 name is used as a file name.
4549
4550 none don't load any stat for this backend
4551
4552 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004553 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4554 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4555 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4556 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4557 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004558
4559 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4560 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4561
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004562 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004563
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004564 global
4565 stats socket /tmp/socket
4566 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004567
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004568 defaults
4569 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004570
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004571 backend bk
4572 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4573 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004574
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004575
4576 Then one can run :
4577
4578 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4579
4580 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4581
4582 1
4583 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4584 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4585 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4586
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004587 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004588
4589 global
4590 stats socket /tmp/socket
4591 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4592
4593 defaults
4594 load-server-state-from-file local
4595
4596 backend bk
4597 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4598 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4599
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004600
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004601 Then one can run :
4602
4603 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4604
4605 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4606
4607 1
4608 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4609 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4610 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4611
4612 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4613 "show servers state"
4614
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004615
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004616log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004617log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004618no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004619 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4621 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004622
4623 Prefix :
4624 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4625 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4626 prefix does not allow arguments.
4627
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004628 Arguments :
4629 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4630 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4631 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4632 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4633 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4634 parameter.
4635
4636 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4637 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4638
4639 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4640 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4641 standard syslog port).
4642
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004643 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4644 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4645 standard syslog port).
4646
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004647 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4648 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4649 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4650 appropriately writeable).
4651
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004652 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4653 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004654
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004655 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4656 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4657 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4658 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4659 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4660 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4661 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4662 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4663 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4664 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4665 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4666
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004667 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4668
4669 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4670 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4671 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4672
4673 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4674 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4675 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004676 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4677 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4678 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4679 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4680 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004681
4682 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4683
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004684 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4685 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4686 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004687
4688 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4689 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4690 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4691 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4692
4693 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4694 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004695
4696 Example :
4697 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004698 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4699 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004700 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004702
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004703log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004704 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004707
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004708 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4709 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4710 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4711 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4712 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004713
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004714log-format-sd <string>
4715 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4717 yes | yes | yes | no
4718
4719 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4720 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4721 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4722 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4723 which covers the log format string in depth.
4724
4725 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4726 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4727
4728 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4729 log format to "rfc5424".
4730
4731 Example :
4732 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4733
4734
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004735log-tag <string>
4736 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4738 yes | yes | yes | yes
4739
4740 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4741 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4742 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4743 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4744 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4745 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4746 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4747 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4748 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004749
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004750max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4751 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4752 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4753 yes | no | yes | yes
4754
4755 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4756 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4757 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4758 servers.
4759
4760 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4761 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4762 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4763 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4764 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4765 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4766 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4767 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4768 picking a different server.
4769
4770 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4771 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4772 even if they have to be queued.
4773
4774 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4775 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4776
4777
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004778maxconn <conns>
4779 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | yes | yes | no
4782 Arguments :
4783 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4784 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4785 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4786 closes.
4787
4788 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4789 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4790 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4791 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004792 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4793 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4794 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4795 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004796
4797 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4798 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4799 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4800
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004801 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004803 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4804
4805
4806mode { tcp|http|health }
4807 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | yes | yes | yes
4810 Arguments :
4811 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4812 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4813 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4814 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4815
4816 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4817 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4818 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4819 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4820 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4821
4822 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004823 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4824 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4825 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4826 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4827 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4828 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4829 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004830
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004831 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4832 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4833 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004834
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004835 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004836 defaults http_instances
4837 mode http
4838
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004839 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004841
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004842monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004843 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004846 Arguments :
4847 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4848 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004849 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004850 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4851 backend and its backup.
4852
4853 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4854 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4855 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4856 servers in a list of backends.
4857
4858 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4859 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4860 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4861 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4862 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4863 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4864 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004865 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4866 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004867
4868 Example:
4869 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004870 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4872 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4873 monitor-uri /site_alive
4874 monitor fail if site_dead
4875
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004876 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004877
4878
4879monitor-net <source>
4880 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 yes | yes | yes | no
4883 Arguments :
4884 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4885 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4886 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4887 followed by a mask.
4888
4889 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4890 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004891 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004892 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4893
4894 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4895 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4896 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4897 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004898 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4899 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4900 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004901
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004902 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4903 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4904 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4905 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4906 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4907 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004908
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004909 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4910 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004911
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004912 Example :
4913 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4914 frontend www
4915 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4916
4917 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4918
4919
4920monitor-uri <uri>
4921 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4923 yes | yes | yes | no
4924 Arguments :
4925 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4926 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4927
4928 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4929 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4930 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4931 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4932 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4933 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4934 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4935 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4936
4937 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4938 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4939 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4940 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4941 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4942 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4943
4944 Example :
4945 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4946 frontend www
4947 mode http
4948 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4949
4950 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004952
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004953option abortonclose
4954no option abortonclose
4955 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4957 yes | no | yes | yes
4958 Arguments : none
4959
4960 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4961 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4962 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4963 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004964 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004965 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4966 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4967 encountered while delivering the response.
4968
4969 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4970 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4971 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4972 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4973 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4974 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004975 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004976 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004977 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004978 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4979 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4980 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4981
4982 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4983 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4984 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4985 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4986 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4987 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4988 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4989 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004990 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004991
4992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4994
4995 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4996
4997
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004998option accept-invalid-http-request
4999no option accept-invalid-http-request
5000 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5002 yes | yes | yes | no
5003 Arguments : none
5004
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005005 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005006 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5007 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5008 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5009 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5010 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5011 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5012 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005013 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5014 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5015 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5016 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5017 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005018 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005019 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5020 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5021 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005022
5023 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5024 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5025 been confirmed.
5026
5027 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5028 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005029 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5030 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005031 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5032
5033 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5034 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5035
5036 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5037 stats socket.
5038
5039
5040option accept-invalid-http-response
5041no option accept-invalid-http-response
5042 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5044 yes | no | yes | yes
5045 Arguments : none
5046
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005047 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005048 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5049 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5050 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5051 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5052 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5053 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5054 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005055 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5056 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5057 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005058
5059 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5060 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5061 been confirmed.
5062
5063 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5064 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5065 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5066 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5067
5068 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5069 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5070
5071 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5072 stats socket.
5073
5074
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005075option allbackups
5076no option allbackups
5077 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 yes | no | yes | yes
5080 Arguments : none
5081
5082 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5083 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5084 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5085 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5086 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5087 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5088 order between the backup servers anymore.
5089
5090 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5091 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5092
5093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5095
5096
5097option checkcache
5098no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005099 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5101 yes | no | yes | yes
5102 Arguments : none
5103
5104 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5105 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005106 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005107 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5108 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005109 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005110
5111 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005112 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005113 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005114 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5115 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005116 to the client are :
5117 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005118 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005119 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005120 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5121 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5122 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5123 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5124 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5125 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5126 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5127 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5128 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5129 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5130 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5131
5132 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005133 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005134 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005135 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005136 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5137
5138 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5139 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005140 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005141 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5142
5143 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5144 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5145
5146
5147option clitcpka
5148no option clitcpka
5149 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5151 yes | yes | yes | no
5152 Arguments : none
5153
5154 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5155 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5156 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5157 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5158
5159 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5160 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5161 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5162 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5163
5164 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5165 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5166 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5167 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5168 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5169
5170 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5171
5172 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5173 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5174 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5175
5176 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5177 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5178
5179 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5180
5181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005182option contstats
5183 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5185 yes | yes | yes | no
5186 Arguments : none
5187
5188 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5189 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5190 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5191 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005192 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5193 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5194 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5195 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5196 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005197
5198
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005199option dontlog-normal
5200no option dontlog-normal
5201 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5203 yes | yes | yes | no
5204 Arguments : none
5205
5206 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5207 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5208 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5209 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5210 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5211 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5212 logged.
5213
5214 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5215 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5216 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005218 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005219 logging.
5220
5221
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005222option dontlognull
5223no option dontlognull
5224 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | yes | yes | no
5227 Arguments : none
5228
5229 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5230 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5231 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5232 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5233 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5234 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005235 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5236 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5237 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005238
5239 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5240 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5241 would not be logged.
5242
5243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5245
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005246 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5247 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005248
5249
5250option forceclose
5251no option forceclose
5252 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005254 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005255 Arguments : none
5256
5257 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5258 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5259 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5260 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5261 global session times in the logs.
5262
5263 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005264 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005265 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005266
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005267 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5268 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5269 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5270
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005271 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5272 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005273
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005274 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5275 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5276
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005277 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005278
5279
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005280option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005281 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | yes | yes | yes
5284 Arguments :
5285 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5286 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005287 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005288 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005289
5290 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5291 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5292 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5293 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5294 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5295 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5296 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005297 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5298 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5299 possible that the client has already brought one.
5300
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005301 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005302 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005303 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5304 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005305 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5306 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005307
5308 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5309 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5310 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5311 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5312 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5313 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5314 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5315
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005316 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5317 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5318 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5319 are under the control of the end-user.
5320
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005321 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005322 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5323 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005324 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5325 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5326 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005327
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005328 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005329 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5330 frontend www
5331 mode http
5332 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5333
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005334 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5335 backend www
5336 mode http
5337 option forwardfor header X-Client
5338
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005339 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005340 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005341
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005342
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005343option http-buffer-request
5344no option http-buffer-request
5345 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5347 yes | yes | yes | yes
5348 Arguments : none
5349
5350 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5351 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5352 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5353 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5354 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5355 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5356 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5357 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5358 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5359 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5360 default.
5361
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005362 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005363
5364
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005365option http-ignore-probes
5366no option http-ignore-probes
5367 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5369 yes | yes | yes | no
5370 Arguments : none
5371
5372 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5373 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5374 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5375 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5376 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5377 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5378 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5379 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5380 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5381 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5382 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5383 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5384
5385 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5386 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5387 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5388 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5389 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5390 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5391 are often the only way to detect them.
5392
5393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5395
5396 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5397
5398
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005399option http-keep-alive
5400no option http-keep-alive
5401 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5403 yes | yes | yes | yes
5404 Arguments : none
5405
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005406 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5407 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5408 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5409 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5410 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5411 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5412 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5413
5414 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5415 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005416 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5417 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5418 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5419 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5420 situations where this option may be useful :
5421
5422 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5423 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5424
5425 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5426 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5427
5428 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5429 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5430 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5431 request.
5432
5433 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5434 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005435 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5436 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5437 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005438
5439 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5440 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5441
5442 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5443 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5444 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5445 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5446 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5447 not set.
5448
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005449 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5450 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005451 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005452 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005453
5454 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005455 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5456 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005457
5458
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005459option http-no-delay
5460no option http-no-delay
5461 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5463 yes | yes | yes | yes
5464 Arguments : none
5465
5466 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5467 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5468 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5469 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5470 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5471 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5472 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5473 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5474 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5475 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5476 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5477 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5478 affected.
5479
5480 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5481 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5482 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5483 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5484 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5485 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5486 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5487 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5488 latency environments.
5489
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005490 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5491
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005492
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005493option http-pretend-keepalive
5494no option http-pretend-keepalive
5495 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5497 yes | yes | yes | yes
5498 Arguments : none
5499
5500 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5501 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5502 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5503 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5504 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5505 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5506 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5507 consider the response complete.
5508
5509 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5510 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5511 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5512 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5513 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5514 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5515
5516 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5517 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5518 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5519 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5520 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5521 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5522 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5523
5524 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5525 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005526 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005527 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5528 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005529
5530 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5531 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5532
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005533 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5534 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005535
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005536
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005537option http-server-close
5538no option http-server-close
5539 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5541 yes | yes | yes | yes
5542 Arguments : none
5543
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005544 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5545 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5546 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5547 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5548 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5549 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5550 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5551 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5552 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5553 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5554 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5555 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5556 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5557 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5558 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5559 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005560
5561 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5562 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5563 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5564 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005565 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5566 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005567
5568 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5569 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005570 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5571 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005572 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5573 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005574
5575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5577
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005578 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005579 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5580 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005581
5582
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005583option http-tunnel
5584no option http-tunnel
5585 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5587 yes | yes | yes | yes
5588 Arguments : none
5589
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005590 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5591 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5592 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5593 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5594 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5595 "option http-tunnel".
5596
5597 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005598 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005599 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5600 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5601 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5602 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5603 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5604 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5605 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005606
5607 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5608 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5609
5610 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5611 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5612 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5613
5614
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005615option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005616no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005617 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5619 yes | yes | yes | no
5620 Arguments : none
5621
5622 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5623 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5624 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5625 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5626 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5627 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5628 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5629
5630 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5631 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005632 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5633 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5634 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005635
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005636 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5637 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5638 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5639 front of an existing proxy.
5640
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005641 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5642
5643 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5644 http-server-close".
5645
5646
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005647option httpchk
5648option httpchk <uri>
5649option httpchk <method> <uri>
5650option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5651 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5653 yes | no | yes | yes
5654 Arguments :
5655 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5656 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5657 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5658 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5659 ones.
5660
5661 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5662 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5663 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5664
5665 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5666 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5667 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5668 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5669 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5670
5671 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5672 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5673 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5674 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5675 the lack of any response.
5676
5677 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5678
5679 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5680 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5681 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5682
5683 Examples :
5684 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5685 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5686 backend https_relay
5687 mode tcp
5688 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5689 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5690
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005691 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5692 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5693 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005694
5695
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005696option httpclose
5697no option httpclose
5698 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5700 yes | yes | yes | yes
5701 Arguments : none
5702
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005703 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5704 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5705 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5706 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005707 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005708 "option http-tunnel".
5709
5710 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5711 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5712 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5713 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5714 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5715 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5716 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5717 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005718
5719 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005720 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005721 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5722 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5723 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5724 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5725 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005726
5727 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5728 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005729 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5730 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005731 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5732 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005733
5734 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5735 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5736
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005737 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5738 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005739
5740
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005741option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005742 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005745 Arguments :
5746 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5747 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5748 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5749 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5750 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005751
5752 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5753 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5754 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5755 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5756 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5757 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5758 ports.
5759
5760 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5761
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005762 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5763 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005765 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005766
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005767
5768option http_proxy
5769no option http_proxy
5770 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5772 yes | yes | yes | yes
5773 Arguments : none
5774
5775 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5776 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5777 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5778 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5779 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5780
5781 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5782 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005783 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5784 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005785
5786 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5787 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5788
5789 Example :
5790 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5791 backend direct_forward
5792 option httpclose
5793 option http_proxy
5794
5795 See also : "option httpclose"
5796
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005797
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005798option independent-streams
5799no option independent-streams
5800 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5802 yes | yes | yes | yes
5803 Arguments : none
5804
5805 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5806 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5807 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5808 receive data or not.
5809
5810 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5811 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5812 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5813 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5814 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5815 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5816 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5817 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5818 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5819 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5820 socket buffers.
5821
5822 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5823 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5824 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5825 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5826 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5827
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005828 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005829 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5830 deprecated.
5831
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005832 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005833
5834
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005835option ldap-check
5836 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5838 yes | no | yes | yes
5839 Arguments : none
5840
5841 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5842 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5843 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5844 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5845
5846 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5847 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5848
5849 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5850 configure it.
5851
5852 Example :
5853 option ldap-check
5854
5855 See also : "option httpchk"
5856
5857
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005858option external-check
5859 Use external processes for server health checks
5860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5861 yes | no | yes | yes
5862
5863 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5864 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5865 command".
5866
5867 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5868
5869 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5870
5871
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005872option log-health-checks
5873no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005874 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5876 yes | no | yes | yes
5877 Arguments : none
5878
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005879 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5880 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5881 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005882
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005883 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5884 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5885 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5886 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5887 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5888
5889 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5890 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005891
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005892 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5893 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5894 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005895
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005896
5897option log-separate-errors
5898no option log-separate-errors
5899 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5901 yes | yes | yes | no
5902 Arguments : none
5903
5904 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5905 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5906 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5907 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5908 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5909 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5910 provides very important information.
5911
5912 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5913 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5914 error logs.
5915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005916 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005917 logging.
5918
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005919
5920option logasap
5921no option logasap
5922 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5924 yes | yes | yes | no
5925 Arguments : none
5926
5927 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5928 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5929 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5930 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5931 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5932 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5933 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005934 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005935 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5936 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5937
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005938 Examples :
5939 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5940 mode http
5941 option httplog
5942 option logasap
5943 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5944
5945 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5946 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5947 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5948 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005950 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005951 logging.
5952
5953
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005954option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005955 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5957 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005958 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005959 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5960 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005961 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005962
5963 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5964 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5965 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5966 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5967 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5968 in the MySQL table, like this :
5969
5970 USE mysql;
5971 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5972 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5973
5974 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5975 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5976 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5977 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5978 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5979 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5980 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5981 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5982 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5983
5984 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5985 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005986
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005987 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005988
5989 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5990 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5991 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5992 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005993 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5994 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005995
5996 See also: "option httpchk"
5997
5998
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005999option nolinger
6000no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006001 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6003 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006004 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006005
6006 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6007 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6008 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6009 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6010 connections.
6011
6012 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6013 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6014 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6015 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6016 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6017 this too.
6018
6019 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6020 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6021 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6022
6023 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6024 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6025 for servers.
6026
6027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6029
6030
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006031option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6032 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6034 yes | yes | yes | yes
6035 Arguments :
6036 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6037 matching <network>
6038 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6039 header name.
6040
6041 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6042 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6043 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6044 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6045 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6046 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6047 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6048 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6049 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6050 possible that the client has already brought one.
6051
6052 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6053 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6054 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6055 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6056 header and requires different one.
6057
6058 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6059 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6060 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6061 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6062 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6063 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6064 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6065
6066 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6067 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6068 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6069 both are defined.
6070
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006071 Examples :
6072 # Original Destination address
6073 frontend www
6074 mode http
6075 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6076
6077 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6078 backend www
6079 mode http
6080 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6081
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006082 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6083 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006084
6085
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006086option persist
6087no option persist
6088 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6089 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6090 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006091 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006092
6093 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6094 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6095 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6096 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6097 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6098 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6099 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6100 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6101 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6102 redirected to another valid server.
6103
6104 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6105 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6106
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006107 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006108
6109
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006110option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6111 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6113 yes | no | yes | yes
6114 Arguments :
6115 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6116 PostgreSQL server.
6117
6118 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6119 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6120 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6121 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6122
6123 See also: "option httpchk"
6124
6125
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006126option prefer-last-server
6127no option prefer-last-server
6128 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6129 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | no | yes | yes
6131 Arguments : none
6132
6133 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6134 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6135 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6136 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6137 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6138 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6139 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6140 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6141 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006142 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6143 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6144 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6145 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6146 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6147 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6148 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006149
6150 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6151 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6152
6153 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6154
6155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006156option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006157option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006158no option redispatch
6159 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6160 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6161 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006162 Arguments :
6163 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6164 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6165 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6166 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6167 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6168 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6169 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6170 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6171 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006173
6174 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6175 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6176 be able to access the service anymore.
6177
6178 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6179 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6180
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006181 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006182 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6183 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006184
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006185 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6186 "redisp" keywords.
6187
6188 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6189 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6190
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006191 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006192
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006193
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006194option redis-check
6195 Use redis health checks for server testing
6196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6197 yes | no | yes | yes
6198 Arguments : none
6199
6200 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6201 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6202 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6203 find the "+PONG" response message.
6204
6205 Example :
6206 option redis-check
6207
6208 See also : "option httpchk"
6209
6210
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006211option smtpchk
6212option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6213 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6215 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006216 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006217 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6218 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6219 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6220
6221 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6222 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6223 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6224
6225 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6226 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6227 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6228 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6229 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6230 dead server.
6231
6232 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6233 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6234 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6235 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6236
6237 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6238 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6239 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6240 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006241 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006242
6243 Example :
6244 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6245
6246 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006249option socket-stats
6250no option socket-stats
6251
6252 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6254 yes | yes | yes | no
6255
6256 Arguments : none
6257
6258
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006259option splice-auto
6260no option splice-auto
6261 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6263 yes | yes | yes | yes
6264 Arguments : none
6265
6266 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6267 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6268 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6269 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006270 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006271 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6272 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6273 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6274 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6275
6276 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6277 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6278 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6279 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6280 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6281 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6282 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6283 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6284 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6285 keyword.
6286
6287 Example :
6288 option splice-auto
6289
6290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6292
6293 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6294 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6295
6296
6297option splice-request
6298no option splice-request
6299 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6301 yes | yes | yes | yes
6302 Arguments : none
6303
6304 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006305 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006306 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6307 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6308 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6309 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6310
6311 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6312
6313 Example :
6314 option splice-request
6315
6316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6318
6319 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6320 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6321
6322
6323option splice-response
6324no option splice-response
6325 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6327 yes | yes | yes | yes
6328 Arguments : none
6329
6330 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006331 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006332 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6333 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6334 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6335 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6336
6337 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6338
6339 Example :
6340 option splice-response
6341
6342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6344
6345 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6346 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6347
6348
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006349option srvtcpka
6350no option srvtcpka
6351 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6353 yes | no | yes | yes
6354 Arguments : none
6355
6356 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6357 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6358 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6359 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6360
6361 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6362 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6363 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6364 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6365
6366 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6367 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6368 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6369 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6370 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6371
6372 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6373
6374 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6375 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6376 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6377
6378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6380
6381 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6382
6383
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006384option ssl-hello-chk
6385 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6387 yes | no | yes | yes
6388 Arguments : none
6389
6390 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6391 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6392 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6393 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6394 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6395 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6396 hello message.
6397
6398 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6399 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6400 messages, which is appreciable.
6401
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006402 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6403 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6404 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006405
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006406 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6407
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006408
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006409option tcp-check
6410 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6412 yes | no | yes | yes
6413
6414 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6415 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6416
6417 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6418 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6419 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6420
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006421 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006422 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6423 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6424 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6425 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6426 only.
6427
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006428 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006429 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6430 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6431 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6432 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6433
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006434 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006435 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6436 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006437 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006438 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6439 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6440 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6441 the respective protocols.
6442 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6443 analysed.
6444
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006445 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6446 script.
6447
6448 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6449 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6450 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6451 The "comment" is of course optional.
6452
6453
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006454 Examples :
6455 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6456 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006457 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006458
6459 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6460 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006461 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006462
6463 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6464 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006465 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006466 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006467 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006468 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006469 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006470 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006471 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6472 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006473 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006474 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6475 tcp-check expect string +OK
6476
6477 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6478 (send many headers before analyzing)
6479 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006480 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006481 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6482 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6483 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6484 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006485 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006486
6487
6488 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6489
6490
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006491option tcp-smart-accept
6492no option tcp-smart-accept
6493 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6495 yes | yes | yes | no
6496 Arguments : none
6497
6498 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6499 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6500 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6501 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6502 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6503 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6504
6505 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6506 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6507 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6508 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6509
6510 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6511 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6512 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6513 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6514
6515 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6516 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6517 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6518
6519 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6520 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6521 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6522
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006523 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6524
6525
6526option tcp-smart-connect
6527no option tcp-smart-connect
6528 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6530 yes | no | yes | yes
6531 Arguments : none
6532
6533 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6534 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6535 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6536 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6537 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6538
6539 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6540 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6541 complex.
6542
6543 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6544 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6545 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6546
6547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6549
6550 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6551
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006552
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006553option tcpka
6554 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6556 yes | yes | yes | yes
6557 Arguments : none
6558
6559 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6560 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6561 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6562 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6563
6564 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6565 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6566 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6567 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6568
6569 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6570 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6571 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6572 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6573 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6574
6575 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6576
6577 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6578 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6579 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6580 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6581 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6582 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6583 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6584 backends.
6585
6586 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6587
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006588
6589option tcplog
6590 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6592 yes | yes | yes | yes
6593 Arguments : none
6594
6595 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6596 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6597 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6598 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6599 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6600 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6601 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6602 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6603
6604 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006606 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006607
6608
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006609option transparent
6610no option transparent
6611 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006613 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006614 Arguments : none
6615
6616 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6617 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6618 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6619 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6620 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6621 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6622 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6623 appropriate server.
6624
6625 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6626 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6627
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006628 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006629 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006630
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006631
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006632external-check command <command>
6633 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6635 yes | no | yes | yes
6636
6637 Arguments :
6638 <command> is the external command to run
6639
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006640 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6641
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006642 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006643
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006644 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6645 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6646 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6647 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6648 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6649 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006650
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006651 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6652
6653 Environment variables :
6654 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6655 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6656
6657 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6658
6659 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6660
6661 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6662 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6663 for a UNIX socket).
6664
6665 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6666
6667 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6668
6669 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6670
6671 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6672
6673 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6674
6675 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6676 socket).
6677
6678 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6679 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6680
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006681 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6682 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6683 failed.
6684
6685 Example :
6686 external-check command /bin/true
6687
6688 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6689
6690
6691external-check path <path>
6692 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 yes | no | yes | yes
6695
6696 Arguments :
6697 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6698
6699 The default path is "".
6700
6701 Example :
6702 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6703
6704 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6705 "external-check command"
6706
6707
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006708persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006709persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006710 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 yes | no | yes | yes
6713 Arguments :
6714 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006715 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6716 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006717
6718 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6719 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6720 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6721 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6722 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6723 forwarded to this server.
6724
6725 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6726 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6727 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006728 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006729 a single "listen" section.
6730
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006731 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6732 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6733 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6734
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006735 Example :
6736 listen tse-farm
6737 bind :3389
6738 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6739 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6740 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6741 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6742 persist rdp-cookie
6743 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006744 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006745 balance rdp-cookie
6746 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6747 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6748
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006749 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6750 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006751
6752
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006753rate-limit sessions <rate>
6754 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6756 yes | yes | yes | no
6757 Arguments :
6758 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6759 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6760
6761 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6762 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6763 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6764 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6765 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6766 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6767
6768 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6769 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6770 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6771 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6772
6773 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6774 listen smtp
6775 mode tcp
6776 bind :25
6777 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006778 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006779
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006780 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6781 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6782 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006783
6784 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6785
6786
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006787redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6788redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6789redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006790 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6792 no | yes | yes | yes
6793
6794 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006795 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006796
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006797 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006798 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006799 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6800 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6801 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006802
6803 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6804 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6805 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6806 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6807 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006808 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6809 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6810 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6811 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006812
6813 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6814 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6815 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6816 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6817 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6818 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006819 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006820 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006821 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6822 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6823 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006824
6825 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006826 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6827 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6828 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006829 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006830 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6831 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6832 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6833 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006834
6835 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6836 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6837
6838 - "drop-query"
6839 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6840 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6841 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6842 with a location-type redirect.
6843
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006844 - "append-slash"
6845 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6846 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6847 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6848 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6849
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006850 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6851 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6852 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6853 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6854 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6855 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6856 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6857
6858 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6859 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6860 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6861 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6862 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6863 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6864 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006865
6866 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6867 acl clear dst_port 80
6868 acl secure dst_port 8080
6869 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006870 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006871 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006872 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6873
6874 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006875 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6876 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6877 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006878 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006879
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006880 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6881 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6882 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6883
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006884 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006885 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006886
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006887 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006888 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6889 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6890 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006892 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006893
6894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006895redisp (deprecated)
6896redispatch (deprecated)
6897 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6898 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6899 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006900 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006901
6902 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6903 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6904 be able to access the service anymore.
6905
6906 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6907 redistribute them to a working server.
6908
6909 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6910 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6911 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006913 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6914 "option redispatch" instead.
6915
6916 See also : "option redispatch"
6917
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006918
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006919reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006920 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6922 no | yes | yes | yes
6923 Arguments :
6924 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6925 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006926 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006927
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006928 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6929 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6930
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006931 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6932 the last header of an HTTP request.
6933
6934 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6935 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6936 responses.
6937
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006938 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6939 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6940 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6941
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006942 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6943 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006944
6945
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006946reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6947reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006948 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 no | yes | yes | yes
6951 Arguments :
6952 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6953 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6954 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6955 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6956 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6957 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6958 ignores case.
6959
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006960 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6961 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6962
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006963 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6964 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6965 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6966 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006967 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006968
6969 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6970 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6971
6972 Example :
6973 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6974 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6975 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6976
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006977 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6978 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006979
6980
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006981reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6982reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006983 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6985 no | yes | yes | yes
6986 Arguments :
6987 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6988 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6989 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6990 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6991 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6992 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6993
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006994 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6995 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6996
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006997 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6998 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6999 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7000 next servers.
7001
7002 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7003 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7004 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7005
7006 Example :
7007 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7008 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7009 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7010
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007011 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7012 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007013
7014
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007015reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7016reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007017 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 no | yes | yes | yes
7020 Arguments :
7021 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7022 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7023 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7024 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7025 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7026 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7027 case.
7028
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007029 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7030 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7031
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007032 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7033 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7034 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7035 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007036 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007037
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007038 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007039 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007040 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007041
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007042 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7043 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7044
7045 Example :
7046 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7047 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7048 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7049
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007050 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7051 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007052
7053
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007054reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7055reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007056 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7058 no | yes | yes | yes
7059 Arguments :
7060 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7061 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7062 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7063 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7064 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7065 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7066 case.
7067
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007068 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7069 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7070
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007071 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7072 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7073 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7074 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7075
7076 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7077 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7078
7079 Example :
7080 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7081 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7082 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7083 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7084
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007085 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7086 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007087
7088
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007089reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7090reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007091 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7093 no | yes | yes | yes
7094 Arguments :
7095 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7096 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7097 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7098 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7099 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7100 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7101
7102 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7103 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7104 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7105 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007106 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007107
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007108 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7109 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7110
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007111 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7112 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7113 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7114
7115 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7116 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7117 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7118 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7119 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7120
7121 Example :
7122 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007123 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007124 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7125 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7126
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007127 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7128 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007129
7130
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007131reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7132reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007133 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7135 no | yes | yes | yes
7136 Arguments :
7137 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7138 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7139 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7140 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7141 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7142 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7143 ignores case.
7144
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007145 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7146 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7147
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007148 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7149 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007150 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7151 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7152 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007153 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7154 not set.
7155
7156 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7157 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7158 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7159 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7160 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7161
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007162 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007163 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7164 # block all others.
7165 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7166 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7167
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007168 # block bad guys
7169 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7170 reqitarpit . if badguys
7171
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007172 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7173 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007174
7175
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007176retries <value>
7177 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7179 yes | no | yes | yes
7180 Arguments :
7181 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7182 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7183 default value is 3.
7184
7185 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7186 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7187 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7188
7189 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007190 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7191 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007192
7193 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7194 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7195
7196 See also : "option redispatch"
7197
7198
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007199rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007200 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7202 no | yes | yes | yes
7203 Arguments :
7204 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7205 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007206 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007207
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007208 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7209 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7210
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007211 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7212 the last header of an HTTP response.
7213
7214 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7215 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7216 responses.
7217
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007218 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7219 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007220
7221
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007222rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7223rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007224 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7226 no | yes | yes | yes
7227 Arguments :
7228 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7229 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7230 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7231 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7232 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7233 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7234 ignores case.
7235
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007236 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7237 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7238
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007239 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7240 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007241 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007242 client.
7243
7244 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7245 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7246 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7247
7248 Example :
7249 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007250 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007251
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007252 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7253 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007254
7255
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007256rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7257rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007258 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7260 no | yes | yes | yes
7261 Arguments :
7262 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7263 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7264 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7265 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7266 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7267 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7268 ignores case.
7269
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007270 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7271 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7272
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007273 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7274 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7275 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7276 case-sensitive.
7277
7278 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007279 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7280 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7281 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007282
7283 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7284 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7285
7286 Example :
7287 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7288 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7289
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007290 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7291 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007292
7293
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007294rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7295rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007296 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7298 no | yes | yes | yes
7299 Arguments :
7300 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7301 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7302 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7303 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7304 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7305 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7306 ignores case.
7307
7308 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7309 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7310 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7311 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007312 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007313
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007314 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7315 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7316
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007317 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7318 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7319 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7320
7321 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7322 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7323 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7324 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7325 are not case-sensitive.
7326
7327 Example :
7328 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7329 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7330
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007331 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7332 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007333
7334
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007335server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007336 Declare a server in a backend
7337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7338 no | no | yes | yes
7339 Arguments :
7340 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007341 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007342 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007343
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007344 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7345 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7346 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7347 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007348 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7349 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7350 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7351 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7352 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007353 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7354 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7355 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7356 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7357 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7358 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7359 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007360 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007361 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7362 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007363 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7364 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007365
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007366 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007367 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7368 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7369 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7370 adding this value to the client's port.
7371
7372 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7373 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007374 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007375
7376 Examples :
7377 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7378 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007379 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007380 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7381 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7382 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007383
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007384 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7385 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7386 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7387 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7388 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7389
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007390 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7391 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007392
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007393server-state-file-name [<file>]
7394 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7395 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7396 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7397 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7398 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7399 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7400
7401 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7402 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7403
7404 global
7405 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7406
7407 backend bk
7408 load-server-state-from-file
7409
7410 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7411 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007412
7413source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007414source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007415source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007416 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7418 yes | no | yes | yes
7419 Arguments :
7420 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7421 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007422
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007423 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007424 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7425 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7426 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7427 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7428 supported prefixes are :
7429 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7430 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7431 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007432 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007433 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7434 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007435
7436 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7437 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007438 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7439 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7440 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007441
7442 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7443 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7444 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7445 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7446 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7447 <addr>.
7448
7449 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7450 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7451 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7452 port.
7453
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007454 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7455 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7456 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7457 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007458 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007459 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7460 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7461 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7462 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7463 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7464 HTTP header.
7465
7466 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7467 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007468 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007469 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7470 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7471 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7472 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7473 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7474 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7475 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7476
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007477 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7478 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7479 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7480 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7481 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7482 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7483
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007484 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7485 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7486 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7487 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7488
7489 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7490 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7491 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7492 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7493 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7494 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7495
7496 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7497 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7498 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7499 there are two methods :
7500
7501 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7502 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7503 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7504 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7505 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7506 of the client ranges may be used.
7507
7508 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7509 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7510 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7511 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7512 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7513 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7514 same session.
7515
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007516 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7517 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7518 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007519 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007520
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007521 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7522
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007523 Examples :
7524 backend private
7525 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7526 source 192.168.1.200
7527
7528 backend transparent_ssl1
7529 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7530 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7531
7532 backend transparent_ssl2
7533 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7534 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7535 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7536
7537 backend transparent_ssl3
7538 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7539 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7540 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7541
7542 backend transparent_smtp
7543 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7544 # with Tproxy version 4.
7545 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7546
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007547 backend transparent_http
7548 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7549 # proxy.
7550 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007552 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007553 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007555
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007556srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7557 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7559 yes | no | yes | yes
7560 Arguments :
7561 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7562 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7563 as explained at the top of this document.
7564
7565 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7566 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7567 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7568 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7569 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7570 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7571 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7572
7573 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7574 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7575 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7576 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7577 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007578 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007579 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007580 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007581
7582 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7583 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7584 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7585 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7586 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7587 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7588
7589 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7590 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7591
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007592 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7593 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007594
7595
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007596stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7597 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007599 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007600
7601 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7602 matched.
7603
7604 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7605 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7606
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007607 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7608 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7609 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7610
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007611 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7612 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7613 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7614 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007615
7616 Example :
7617 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7618 backend stats_localhost
7619 stats enable
7620 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7621
7622 Example :
7623 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7624 backend stats_auth
7625 stats enable
7626 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7627 stats admin if TRUE
7628
7629 Example :
7630 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7631 userlist stats-auth
7632 group admin users admin
7633 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7634 group readonly users haproxy
7635 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7636
7637 backend stats_auth
7638 stats enable
7639 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7640 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7641 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7642 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7643
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007644 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7645 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7646 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007647
7648
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007649stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7650 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007652 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007653 Arguments :
7654 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7655
7656 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7657
7658 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7659 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7660 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7661 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7662 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7663 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7664
7665 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7666 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7667 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007668 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007669
7670 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7671 report using "stats scope".
7672
7673 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7674 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7675 unobvious parameters.
7676
7677 Example :
7678 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7679 backend public_www
7680 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7681 stats enable
7682 stats hide-version
7683 stats scope .
7684 stats uri /admin?stats
7685 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7686 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7687 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7688
7689 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7690 backend private_monitoring
7691 stats enable
7692 stats uri /admin?stats
7693 stats refresh 5s
7694
7695 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7696
7697
7698stats enable
7699 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007701 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007702 Arguments : none
7703
7704 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7705 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7706 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7707 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7708 - stats auth : no authentication
7709 - stats scope : no restriction
7710
7711 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7712 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7713 unobvious parameters.
7714
7715 Example :
7716 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7717 backend public_www
7718 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7719 stats enable
7720 stats hide-version
7721 stats scope .
7722 stats uri /admin?stats
7723 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7724 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7725 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7726
7727 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7728 backend private_monitoring
7729 stats enable
7730 stats uri /admin?stats
7731 stats refresh 5s
7732
7733 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7734
7735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007736stats hide-version
7737 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007739 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007740 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007741
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007742 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7743 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7744 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7745 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7746 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7747 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007749 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7750 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7751 unobvious parameters.
7752
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007753 Example :
7754 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7755 backend public_www
7756 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007757 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007758 stats hide-version
7759 stats scope .
7760 stats uri /admin?stats
7761 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7762 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7763 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007764
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007765 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7766 backend private_monitoring
7767 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007768 stats uri /admin?stats
7769 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007770
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007771 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007772
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007773
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007774stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7775 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7776 Access control for statistics
7777
7778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7779 no | no | yes | yes
7780
7781 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7782 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7783 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7784 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7785 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7786 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7787
7788 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7789 instance.
7790
7791 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7792 about ACL usage.
7793
7794
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007795stats realm <realm>
7796 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007798 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007799 Arguments :
7800 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7801 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7802 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7803
7804 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7805 using a backslash ('\').
7806
7807 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7808 only related to authentication.
7809
7810 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7811 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7812 unobvious parameters.
7813
7814 Example :
7815 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7816 backend public_www
7817 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7818 stats enable
7819 stats hide-version
7820 stats scope .
7821 stats uri /admin?stats
7822 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7823 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7824 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7825
7826 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7827 backend private_monitoring
7828 stats enable
7829 stats uri /admin?stats
7830 stats refresh 5s
7831
7832 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7833
7834
7835stats refresh <delay>
7836 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007838 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007839 Arguments :
7840 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7841 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7842 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7843 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7844 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7845 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7846
7847 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7848 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7849 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7850 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7851
7852 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7853 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7854 unobvious parameters.
7855
7856 Example :
7857 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7858 backend public_www
7859 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7860 stats enable
7861 stats hide-version
7862 stats scope .
7863 stats uri /admin?stats
7864 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7865 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7866 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7867
7868 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7869 backend private_monitoring
7870 stats enable
7871 stats uri /admin?stats
7872 stats refresh 5s
7873
7874 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7875
7876
7877stats scope { <name> | "." }
7878 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007880 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007881 Arguments :
7882 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7883 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7884 section in which the statement appears.
7885
7886 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7887 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7888 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7889 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7890 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7891 exists.
7892
7893 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7894 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7895 unobvious parameters.
7896
7897 Example :
7898 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7899 backend public_www
7900 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7901 stats enable
7902 stats hide-version
7903 stats scope .
7904 stats uri /admin?stats
7905 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7906 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7907 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7908
7909 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7910 backend private_monitoring
7911 stats enable
7912 stats uri /admin?stats
7913 stats refresh 5s
7914
7915 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7916
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007917
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007918stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007919 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007921 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007922
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007923 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007924 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7925
7926 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7927 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7928
7929 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7930 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007931 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007932
7933 Example :
7934 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7935 backend private_monitoring
7936 stats enable
7937 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7938 stats uri /admin?stats
7939 stats refresh 5s
7940
7941 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7942 global section.
7943
7944
7945stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007946 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7948 yes | yes | yes | yes
7949 Arguments : none
7950
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007951 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007952 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7953 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7954 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7955 - IP (socket, server)
7956 - cookie (backend, server)
7957
7958 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7959 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007960 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007961
7962 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7963
7964
7965stats show-node [ <name> ]
7966 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007968 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007969 Arguments:
7970 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7971 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7972
7973 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7974 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007975 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007976
7977 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7978 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7979 unobvious parameters.
7980
7981 Example:
7982 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7983 backend private_monitoring
7984 stats enable
7985 stats show-node Europe-1
7986 stats uri /admin?stats
7987 stats refresh 5s
7988
7989 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7990 section.
7991
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007992
7993stats uri <prefix>
7994 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007996 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007997 Arguments :
7998 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7999 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8000 query string.
8001
8002 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8003 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8004 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8005 possible to reach it in the application.
8006
8007 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008008 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008009 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8010 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8011 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8012 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8013
8014 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8015 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8016 an address or a port to statistics only.
8017
8018 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8019 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8020 unobvious parameters.
8021
8022 Example :
8023 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8024 backend public_www
8025 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8026 stats enable
8027 stats hide-version
8028 stats scope .
8029 stats uri /admin?stats
8030 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8031 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8032 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8033
8034 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8035 backend private_monitoring
8036 stats enable
8037 stats uri /admin?stats
8038 stats refresh 5s
8039
8040 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8041
8042
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008043stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8044 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008046 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008047
8048 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008049 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008050 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8051 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8052 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8053
8054 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8055 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8056 the "stick-table" statement.
8057
8058 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8059 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8060 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8061 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8062 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8063
8064 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8065 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8066 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8067 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8068 transformation rules.
8069
8070 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8071 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8072 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8073 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8074 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8075 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8076 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8077
8078 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8079 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8080 ACL based conditions.
8081
8082 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8083 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8084 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8085 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8086
8087 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8088 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8089 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8090 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8091
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008092 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8093 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8094 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8095
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008096 Example :
8097 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8098 # last 30 minutes
8099 backend pop
8100 mode tcp
8101 balance roundrobin
8102 stick store-request src
8103 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8104 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8105 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8106
8107 backend smtp
8108 mode tcp
8109 balance roundrobin
8110 stick match src table pop
8111 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8112 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8113
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008114 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008115 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008116
8117
8118stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8119 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8121 no | no | yes | yes
8122
8123 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8124 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8125 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8126 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8127
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008128 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8129 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8130 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8131
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008132 Examples :
8133 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008134 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008135
8136 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8137 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8138 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8139
8140
8141 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8142 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8143 backend http
8144 mode http
8145 balance roundrobin
8146 stick on src table https
8147 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8148 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8149 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8150
8151 backend https
8152 mode tcp
8153 balance roundrobin
8154 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8155 stick on src
8156 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8157 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8158
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008159 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008160
8161
8162stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8163 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8165 no | no | yes | yes
8166
8167 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008168 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008169 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8170 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8171 server is selected.
8172
8173 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8174 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8175 the "stick-table" statement.
8176
8177 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8178 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8179 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8180 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8181 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8182 address.
8183
8184 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8185 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8186 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8187 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8188 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8189 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8190 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8191 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8192 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8193 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8194
8195 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8196 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8197 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8198 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8199 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8200 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8201 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8202
8203 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8204 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8205 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8206 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8207
8208 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8209 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8210 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8211 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8212 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8213 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008214 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8215 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8216 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8217 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8218 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8219 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008220
8221 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8222 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8223 the request.
8224
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008225 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8226 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8227 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8228
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008229 Example :
8230 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8231 # last 30 minutes
8232 backend pop
8233 mode tcp
8234 balance roundrobin
8235 stick store-request src
8236 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8237 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8238 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8239
8240 backend smtp
8241 mode tcp
8242 balance roundrobin
8243 stick match src table pop
8244 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8245 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8246
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008247 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008248 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008249
8250
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008251stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008252 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8253 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008254 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008256 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008257
8258 Arguments :
8259 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8260 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8261 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8262 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8263
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008264 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8265 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8266 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8267 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8268
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008269 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8270 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8271 instance.
8272
8273 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8274 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8275 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8276 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8277 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8278 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008279 to 32 characters.
8280
8281 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8282 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8283 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008284 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008285 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8286 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008287
8288 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008289 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8290 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008291 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8292 increase.
8293
8294 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008295 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8296 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8297 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008298
8299 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8300 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8301 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8302 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8303 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8304 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8305 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8306 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8307 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8308 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8309 parameter (see below).
8310
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008311 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8312 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8313 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8314 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8315 soft restart.
8316
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008317 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8318 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008319
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008320 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8321 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8322 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8323 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8324 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008325 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008326 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8327 if not expiration delay is specified.
8328
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008329 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8330 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8331 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8332 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008333 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8334 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8335 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8336 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8337 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8338 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8339 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8340 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8341 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8342 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8343 types and their arguments.
8344
8345 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8346 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8347 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8348 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8349
8350 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8351 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8352 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8353 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8354
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008355 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8356 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8357 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8358 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8359 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8360 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8361
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008362 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8363 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8364 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8365 they were received.
8366
8367 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8368 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8369 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8370 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8371 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8372
8373 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8374 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8375 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8376 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8377 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8378
8379 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8380 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8381 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8382
8383 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8384 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8385 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8386 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8387 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8388
8389 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8390 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8391 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8392 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8393 the client side.
8394
8395 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8396 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8397 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8398 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8399 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8400 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8401 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8402
8403 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8404 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8405 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8406 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8407 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8408 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8409 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8410
8411 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8412 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8413 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8414 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8415 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8416 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8417
8418 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8419 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8420 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8421 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8422
8423 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8424 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8425 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8426 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8427 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8428 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8429 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8430 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8431 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8432 recommended for better fairness.
8433
8434 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8435 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8436 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8437 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8438
8439 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8440 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8441 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8442 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8443 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8444 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8445 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8446 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8447 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8448 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008449
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008450 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8451 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008452 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8453 reference it.
8454
8455 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8456 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008457 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8458 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8459 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008460
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008461 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8462 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8463 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8464 something that can be ignored.
8465
8466 Example:
8467 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8468 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8469 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8470 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8471
8472 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008473 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008474
8475
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008476stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008477 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8479 no | no | yes | yes
8480
8481 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008482 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008483 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8484 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8485 server is selected.
8486
8487 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8488 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8489 the "stick-table" statement.
8490
8491 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8492 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8493 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8494 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8495
8496 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8497 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8498 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8499 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8500 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8501 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008502 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008503 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8504 rules.
8505
8506 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8507 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8508 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8509 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8510 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8511 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8512 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8513
8514 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8515 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8516 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8517 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8518
8519 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8520 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8521 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8522 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8523 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8524 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008525 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8526 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8527 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8528 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8529 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8530 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8531 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8532 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8533 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008534
8535 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8536
8537 Example :
8538 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8539 backend https
8540 mode tcp
8541 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008542 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008543 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008544
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008545 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8546 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8547
8548 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8549 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8550 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8551
8552 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8553 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008554
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008555 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8556 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8557 # at offset 44.
8558
8559 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8560 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8561
8562 # Learn on response if server hello.
8563 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008564
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008565 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8566 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8567
8568 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8569 extraction.
8570
8571
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008572tcp-check connect [params*]
8573 Opens a new connection
8574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8575 no | no | yes | yes
8576
8577 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8578 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8579 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8580
8581 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8582 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8583 of the sequence.
8584
8585 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8586 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8587 do.
8588
8589 Parameters :
8590 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8591 use the TCP connection.
8592
8593 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8594 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8595 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8596
8597 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8598
8599 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8600
8601 Examples:
8602 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8603 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8604 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8605 option tcp-check
8606 tcp-check connect
8607 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8608 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8609 tcp-check send \r\n
8610 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8611 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8612 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8613 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8614 tcp-check send \r\n
8615 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8616 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8617
8618 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8619 option tcp-check
8620 tcp-check connect port 110
8621 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8622 tcp-check connect port 143
8623 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8624 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8625
8626 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8627
8628
8629tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8630 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8631 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8632 no | no | yes | yes
8633
8634 Arguments :
8635 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8636 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8637 binary.
8638 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8639 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8640 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8641
8642 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8643 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8644 with the usual backslash ('\').
8645 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8646 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8647 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8648 used upper or lower case.
8649
8650
8651 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8652
8653 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8654 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8655 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8656 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8657 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8658 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8659 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8660 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8661
8662 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8663 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8664 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8665 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8666 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8667 expression.
8668
8669 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8670 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8671 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8672 this exact hexadecimal string.
8673 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8674
8675 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8676 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8677 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8678 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8679 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8680 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8681 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8682 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8683 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8684 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8685 the null character.
8686
8687 Examples :
8688 # perform a POP check
8689 option tcp-check
8690 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8691
8692 # perform an IMAP check
8693 option tcp-check
8694 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8695
8696 # look for the redis master server
8697 option tcp-check
8698 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008699 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008700 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8701 tcp-check expect string role:master
8702 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8703 tcp-check expect string +OK
8704
8705
8706 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8707 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8708
8709
8710tcp-check send <data>
8711 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8713 no | no | yes | yes
8714
8715 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8716 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8717
8718 Examples :
8719 # look for the redis master server
8720 option tcp-check
8721 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8722 tcp-check expect string role:master
8723
8724 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8725 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8726
8727
8728tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8729 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8730 tcp health check
8731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8732 no | no | yes | yes
8733
8734 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8735 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8736 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8737 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8738 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8739 hexadecimal string.
8740 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8741
8742 Examples :
8743 # redis check in binary
8744 option tcp-check
8745 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8746 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8747
8748
8749 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8750 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8751
8752
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008753tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8754 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8756 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008757 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008758 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8759 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008760
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008761 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008762
8763 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8764 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008765 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8766 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8767 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8768 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8769 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8770 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008771
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008772 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8773 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8774 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8775 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008776
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008777 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008778 - accept :
8779 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8780 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8781 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008782
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008783 - reject :
8784 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8785 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8786 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8787 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8788 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8789 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8790 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8791 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8792 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8793 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8794 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008795 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008796
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008797 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8798 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8799 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8800 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8801 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8802 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8803 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8804 hosts.
8805
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008806 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8807 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8808 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8809 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8810 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8811 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8812 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8813 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8814
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008815 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8816 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8817 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8818 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8819 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8820 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8821 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8822 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8823 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008824 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8825 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008826
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008827 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008828 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008829 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008830 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008831 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8832 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008833 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008834 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8835 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8836 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8837 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8838 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008840 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008841 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008842 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008843 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8844 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8845 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8846 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008847
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008848 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8849 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8850 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8851 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008852
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008853 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8854 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8855 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8856 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8857 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008858 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8859 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8860 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8861 layer7 information is extracted.
8862
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008863 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8864 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8865 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8866 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8867 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008868
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008869 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8870 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8871 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8872 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8873
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008874 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8875 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8876 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8877 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8878 continues.
8879
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008880 - set-src <expr> :
8881 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8882 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8883 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8884 set-src"
8885
8886 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8887 followed by some converters.
8888
8889 Example:
8890
8891 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8892
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008893 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8894 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008895
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008896 - set-src-port <expr> :
8897 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8898 expression.
8899
8900 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8901 followed by some converters.
8902
8903 Example:
8904
8905 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8906
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008907 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8908 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8909 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008910
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008911 - set-dst <expr> :
8912 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8913 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8914 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8915 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8916 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8917
8918 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8919 followed by some converters.
8920
8921 Example:
8922
8923 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8924 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8925
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008926 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
8927 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
8928
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008929 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8930 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8931 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8932 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8933
8934
8935 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8936 followed by some converters.
8937
8938 Example:
8939
8940 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8941
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008942 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
8943 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
8944 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8945
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008946 - "silent-drop" :
8947 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8948 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8949 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8950 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8951 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8952 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8953 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8954 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8955 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8956 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8957 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8958 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8959 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8960 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8961 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8962 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008964 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8965 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8966 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008968 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8969 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8970 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008971
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008972 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008973 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008974 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008976 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8977 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8978 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008980 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008981 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8982 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008983
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008984 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8985
8986 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8987
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008988 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8989
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008990 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008991
8992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008993tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8994 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008996 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008997 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008998 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8999 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009000
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009001 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009003 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9004 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9005 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9006 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9007 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009008
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009009 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9010 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9011 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9012 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009013 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9014 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9015 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9016 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9017 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9018 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009019 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009020 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009022 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9023 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9024 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9025 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009026
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009027 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009028 - accept : the request is accepted
9029 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9030 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009031 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009032 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009033 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009034 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009035 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009037 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9038 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009039
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009040 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9041 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9042 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9043 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9044 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9045 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009047 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009048 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9049 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009050
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009051 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009052 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9053 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9054 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9055 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009056 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9057 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9058 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009059
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009060 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009061 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9062 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9063 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009064
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009065 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009066 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9067 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009068
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009069 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9070 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9071 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9072 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009073 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009074 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009075 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009076 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9077 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009078 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009079 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9080 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009081
9082 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9083 followed by some converters.
9084
9085 Example:
9086
9087 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9088
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009089 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009090 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9091 # and reject everything else.
9092 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9093 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009094 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009095 tcp-request content reject
9096
9097 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009098 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9099 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9100 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009101 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009102
9103 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9104 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9105 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009106 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009107 tcp-request content reject
9108
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009109 Example:
9110 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9111 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009112 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009113
9114 Example:
9115 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9116 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009117 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009119 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9120 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9121
9122 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009123 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009124 # protecting all our sites
9125 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009126 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9127 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009128 ...
9129 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9130
9131 backend http_dynamic
9132 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009133 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009134 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009135 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9136 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9137 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009138 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009140 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009141
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009142 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9143 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009144
9145
9146tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9147 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009149 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009150 Arguments :
9151 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9153 as explained at the top of this document.
9154
9155 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9156 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9157 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9158 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9159 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9160
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009161 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9162 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9163 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9164 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9165
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009166 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9167 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009168 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009169 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009170 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9171 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9172 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9173 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009174
9175 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9176 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9177 it pass through unaffected.
9178
9179 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9180 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9181 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009182 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009183 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9184 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009185 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9186 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9187 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009188
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009189 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009190 "timeout client".
9191
9192
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009193tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9194 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9196 no | no | yes | yes
9197 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009198 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9199 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009200
9201 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9202
9203 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9204 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9205 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009206 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9207 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009208
9209 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9210
9211 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9212 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9213 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9214 inserted.
9215
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009216 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009217 - accept :
9218 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9219 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9220 the rules evaluation.
9221
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009222 - close :
9223 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9224 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9225 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9226 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9227 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9228 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009229 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009230 protocols.
9231
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009232 - reject :
9233 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9234 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009235 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009236
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009237 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9238 Sets a variable.
9239
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009240 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9241 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9242 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9243 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9244
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009245 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9246 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9247 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9248 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9249 continues.
9250
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009251 - "silent-drop" :
9252 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9253 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9254 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9255 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9256 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9257 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9258 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9259 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9260 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9261 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9262 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9263 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9264 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9265 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9266 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9267 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9268
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009269 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9270 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9271 for changing the default action to a reject.
9272
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009273 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9274 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9275 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9276 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009277 period.
9278
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009279 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9280 declared inline.
9281
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009282 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9283 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9284 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9285 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009286 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009287 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009288 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009289 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9290 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009291 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009292 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9293 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009294
9295 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9296 followed by some converters.
9297
9298 Example:
9299
9300 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9301
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009302 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9303
9304 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9305
9306
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009307tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9308 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9310 no | yes | yes | no
9311 Arguments :
9312 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9313 below.
9314
9315 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9316
9317 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9318 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9319 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9320 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9321 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9322 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9323 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9324 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9325 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9326 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9327 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9328 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9329 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9330 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9331 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9332 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9333 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9334 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9335 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9336 instead.
9337
9338 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9339 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9340 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9341 rules which may be inserted.
9342
9343 Several types of actions are supported :
9344 - accept : the request is accepted
9345 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9346 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9347 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9348 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9349 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9350 - silent-drop
9351
9352 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9353 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9354 sections for a complete description.
9355
9356 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9357 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9358 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9359
9360 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9361 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9362 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9363 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9364 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9365
9366 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9367 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9368
9369 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9370 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9371 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9372
9373 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9374 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9375 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9376
9377 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9378 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9379 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9380
9381 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9382 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9383 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9384
9385 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9386
9387 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9388
9389
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009390tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9391 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9393 no | no | yes | yes
9394 Arguments :
9395 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9396 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9397 as explained at the top of this document.
9398
9399 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9400
9401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009402timeout check <timeout>
9403 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9404 established.
9405
9406 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9407 yes | no | yes | yes
9408 Arguments:
9409 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9410 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9411 as explained at the top of this document.
9412
9413 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9414 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9415 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9416 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009417 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9418 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9419 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009420
9421 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9422 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9423
9424 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9425 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009426 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009427
9428 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9429 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9430 forget about it.
9431
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009432 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9433 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009434
9435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009436timeout client <timeout>
9437timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9438 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9440 yes | yes | yes | no
9441 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009442 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9444 as explained at the top of this document.
9445
9446 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9447 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9448 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009449 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9450 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9451 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9452 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009453 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9454 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9455 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009456 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009457 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009458 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9459 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009460 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9461 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009462
9463 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9464 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9465 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9466 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9467 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9468 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9469
9470 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9471 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9472 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9473
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009474 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9475 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009476
9477
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009478timeout client-fin <timeout>
9479 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9481 yes | yes | yes | no
9482 Arguments :
9483 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9484 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9485 as explained at the top of this document.
9486
9487 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9488 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9489 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9490 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9491 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9492 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9493 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9494 down in one direction.
9495
9496 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9497 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9498 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9499
9500 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9501
9502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009503timeout connect <timeout>
9504timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9505 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9507 yes | no | yes | yes
9508 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009509 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9511 as explained at the top of this document.
9512
9513 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009514 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009515 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009516 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009517 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9518 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009519
9520 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9521 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9522 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9523 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9524 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9525 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9526
9527 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9528 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9529 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9530
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009531 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9532 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009533
9534
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009535timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9536 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9538 yes | yes | yes | yes
9539 Arguments :
9540 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9541 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9542 as explained at the top of this document.
9543
9544 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9545 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9546 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9547 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9548 once the request has started to present itself.
9549
9550 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9551 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9552 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9553 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9554 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9555
9556 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9557 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9558 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9559 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9560
9561 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9562 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9563 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9564 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9565 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009566 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009567
9568 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9569 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9570 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9571 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9572
9573 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9574
9575
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009576timeout http-request <timeout>
9577 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009579 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009580 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009581 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009582 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9583 as explained at the top of this document.
9584
9585 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9586 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9587 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9588 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9589 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9590 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9591 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009592 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9593 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9594 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9595 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9596 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009597 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9598 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009599
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009600 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9601 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9602 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9603 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9604 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009605 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009606
9607 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9608 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9609 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9610 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9611 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9612
9613 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009614 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9615 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9616 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009617
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009618 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009619 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009620
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009621
9622timeout queue <timeout>
9623 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9625 yes | no | yes | yes
9626 Arguments :
9627 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9628 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9629 as explained at the top of this document.
9630
9631 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9632 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9633 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9634 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9635 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9636
9637 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9638 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9639 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9640 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9641
9642 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9643
9644
9645timeout server <timeout>
9646timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9647 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9649 yes | no | yes | yes
9650 Arguments :
9651 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9652 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9653 as explained at the top of this document.
9654
9655 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9656 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9657 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9658 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9659 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9660 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9661 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9662
9663 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9664 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9665 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9666 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9667 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009668 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009669 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009670 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9671 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9672 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9673 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009674
9675 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9676 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9677 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9678 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9679 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9680 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9681
9682 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9683 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9684 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9685
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009686 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009687
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009688
9689timeout server-fin <timeout>
9690 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9692 yes | no | yes | yes
9693 Arguments :
9694 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9695 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9696 as explained at the top of this document.
9697
9698 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9699 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9700 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9701 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9702 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9703 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9704 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9705 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9706 situations, it should not be needed.
9707
9708 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9709 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9710 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9711
9712 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9713
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009714
9715timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009716 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9718 yes | yes | yes | yes
9719 Arguments :
9720 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9721 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9722 as explained at the top of this document.
9723
9724 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9725 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9726 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9727
9728 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9729 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9730 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9731 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009732 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009733
9734 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9735
9736
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009737timeout tunnel <timeout>
9738 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9740 yes | no | yes | yes
9741 Arguments :
9742 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9743 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9744 as explained at the top of this document.
9745
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009746 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009747 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9748 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9749 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9750 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9751 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9752 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9753 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9754 specified.
9755
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009756 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9757 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9758 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9759 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9760 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9761 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9762 state.
9763
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009764 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9765 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9766 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9767 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9768 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9769
9770 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9771 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9772 forget about it.
9773
9774 Example :
9775 defaults http
9776 option http-server-close
9777 timeout connect 5s
9778 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009779 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009780 timeout server 30s
9781 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9782
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009783 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009784
9785
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009786transparent (deprecated)
9787 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009789 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009790 Arguments : none
9791
9792 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9793 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9794 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9795 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9796 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9797 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9798 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9799 appropriate server.
9800
9801 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9802
9803 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9804 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9805
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009806 See also: "option transparent"
9807
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009808unique-id-format <string>
9809 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9811 yes | yes | yes | no
9812 Arguments :
9813 <string> is a log-format string.
9814
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009815 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9816 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9817 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9818 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009819
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009820 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9821 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9822 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9823 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9824 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9825 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9826 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9827 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009828
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009829 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9830 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009831
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009832 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009833
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009834 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009835
9836 will generate:
9837
9838 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9839
9840 See also: "unique-id-header"
9841
9842unique-id-header <name>
9843 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9845 yes | yes | yes | no
9846 Arguments :
9847 <name> is the name of the header.
9848
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009849 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9850 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009851
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009852 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009853
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009854 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009855 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9856
9857 will generate:
9858
9859 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9860
9861 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009862
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009863use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009864 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9866 no | yes | yes | no
9867 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009868 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9869 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009870
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009871 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9872 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009873
9874 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9875 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9876 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009877 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9878 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9879 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9880 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009881
9882 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9883 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9884 assign the backend.
9885
9886 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9887 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9888 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9889 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9890 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9891 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9892
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009893 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009894 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009895 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9896 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9897 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9898
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009899 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9900 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9901 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9902 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9903 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9904 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9905 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9906 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9907 cannot be forced from the request.
9908
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009909 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009910 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9911 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9912
9913 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9914 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009915
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009916
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009917use-server <server> if <condition>
9918use-server <server> unless <condition>
9919 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9921 no | no | yes | yes
9922 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009923 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009924
9925 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9926
9927 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9928 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9929 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9930
9931 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9932 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9933 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9934 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9935 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9936 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9937 matches will assign the server.
9938
9939 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9940 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9941 with the next rules until one matches.
9942
9943 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9944 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9945 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9946 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9947
9948 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9949 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9950 stripped.
9951
9952 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9953 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9954 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9955 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9956
9957 Example :
9958 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9959 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9960 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9961 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9962 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9963 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9964 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9965 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9966 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9967
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009968 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009969
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009970
99715. Bind and Server options
9972--------------------------
9973
9974The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9975depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9976settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9977written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9978described in this section.
9979
9980
99815.1. Bind options
9982-----------------
9983
9984The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9985as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9986no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9987parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9988while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9989provided immediately after the setting name.
9990
9991The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9992
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009993accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9994 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9995 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9996 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9997 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9998 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9999 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10000 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10001 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10002 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010003 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10004 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10005 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010006
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010007accept-proxy
10008 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010009 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10010 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010011 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10012 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10013 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10014 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10015 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10016 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10017 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010018 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10019 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010020
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010021alpn <protocols>
10022 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10023 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10024 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10025 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10026 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10027 initial NPN extension.
10028
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010029backlog <backlog>
10030 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10031 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10032
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010033ecdhe <named curve>
10034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010035 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10036 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010037
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010038ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10040 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10041 client's certificate.
10042
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010043ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10045 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10046 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10047 error is ignored.
10048
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010049ca-sign-file <cafile>
10050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10051 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10052 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10053 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10054 'generate-certificates' for details.
10055
10056ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
10057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10058 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10059 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10060 'generate-certificates' for details.
10061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010062ciphers <ciphers>
10063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10064 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010065 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010066 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10067 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10068
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010069crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10071 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10072 to verify client's certificate.
10073
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010074crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10076 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10077 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10078 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10079 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10080 file.
10081
10082 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10083 are loaded.
10084
10085 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010086 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010087 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10088 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10089 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10090 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10091 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10092 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10093 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010094
10095 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10096 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10097 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10098 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010099 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10100 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010101
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010102 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010103
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010104 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10105 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010106 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010107 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10108 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10109 clients).
10110
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010111 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10112 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10113 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10114 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10115 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10116 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10117 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10118 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10119 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10120 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10121 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10122 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10123 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10124
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010125 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10126 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10127 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10128 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10129 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10130
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010131 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10132 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10133 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10134 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010135
10136 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10137 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10138 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10139 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10140 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10141 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10142 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10143 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10144 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10145
10146 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10147
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010148 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010149 a cert bundle.
10150
10151 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10152 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10153 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10154 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10155 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10156 provide multi-cert support.
10157
10158 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10159
10160 Filename | CN | SAN
10161 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10162 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010163 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010164 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10165 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10166
10167 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10168 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10169 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10170 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
10171 suites.
10172
10173 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10174 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10175
10176 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10177 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10178 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10179
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010180crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10182 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010183 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010184 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010185
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010186crt-list <file>
10187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010188 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
10189 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010190
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010191 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010192
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010193 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10194 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10195 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10196 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10197 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10198 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10199 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10200 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010201
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010202 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010203 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
10204 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010205
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010206defer-accept
10207 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10208 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10209 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10210 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10211 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10212 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10213 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10214 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10215 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10216 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10217 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10218
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010219force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010220 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010221 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010222 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10223 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010224
10225force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010226 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010227 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10228 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010229
10230force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010231 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010232 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10233 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010234
10235force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010236 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010237 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10238 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010239
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010240generate-certificates
10241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10242 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10243 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10244 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10245 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10246 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10247 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10248 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10249 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10250 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10251 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10252
10253 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10254 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10255 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10256 certificate is used many times.
10257
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010258gid <gid>
10259 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10260 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10261 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10262 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10263 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10264
10265group <group>
10266 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10267 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10268 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10269 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10270 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10271
10272id <id>
10273 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10274 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10275 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10276 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10277
10278interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010279 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10280 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10281 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10282 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10283 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10284 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10285 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010286
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010287level <level>
10288 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10289 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10290 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10291 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10292 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10293 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10294 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10295 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10296 counters).
10297 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10298 all counters).
10299
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010300maxconn <maxconn>
10301 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10302 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10303 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10304 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10305 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10306 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10307 eat all memory.
10308
10309mode <mode>
10310 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10311 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10312 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10313 UNIX sockets.
10314
10315mss <maxseg>
10316 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10317 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10318 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10319 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10320 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10321 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10322 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10323 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10324 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10325 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10326 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10327
10328name <name>
10329 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10330 page.
10331
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010332namespace <name>
10333 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10334 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10335 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10336 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10337
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010338nice <nice>
10339 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10340 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10341 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10342 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10343 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10344 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10345 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10346 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10347 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10348 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10349 one for an RDP socket.
10350
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010351no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010352 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010353 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010354 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010355 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10356 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010357 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010358
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010359no-tls-tickets
10360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10361 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10362 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010363 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10364 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010365
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010366no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010368 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010369 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010370 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10371 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10372 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010373
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010374no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010375 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010376 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010377 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010378 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10379 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10380 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010381
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010382no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010384 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010385 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010386 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10387 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10388 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010389
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010390npn <protocols>
10391 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10392 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10393 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10394 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010395 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10396 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010397
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010398process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10399 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10400 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10401 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10402 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10403 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10404 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10405 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010406 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10407 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10408 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10409 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10410 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10411 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10412 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010413
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010414ssl
10415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010416 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010417 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10418 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10419 to deciphered contents.
10420
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010421strict-sni
10422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10423 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10424 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10425 See the "crt" option for more information.
10426
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010427tcp-ut <delay>
10428 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10429 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10430 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10431 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10432 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10433 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10434 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10435 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10436 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10437 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10438 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10439
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010440tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010441 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010442 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10443 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10444 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10445 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10446 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10447 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10448 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010449 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10450 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10451 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010452
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010453tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10454 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10455 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10456 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10457 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10458 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10459 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10460 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10461 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10462 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10463 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10464
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010465transparent
10466 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10467 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10468 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10469 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10470 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10471 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10472 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10473 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10474 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10475 so check for support with your vendor.
10476
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010477v4v6
10478 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10479 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10480 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10481 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010482 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010483
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010484v6only
10485 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10486 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10487 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010488 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10489 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010490
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010491uid <uid>
10492 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10493 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10494 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10495 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10496 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10497
10498user <user>
10499 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10500 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10501 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10502 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10503 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10504
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010505verify [none|optional|required]
10506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10507 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10508 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10509 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10510 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010511 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10512 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10513 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10514 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010515
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200105165.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010517------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010519The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10520which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10521arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10522settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10523after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10524Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10525address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010527 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010528 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010530The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010531
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010532addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010533 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010534 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10535 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10536 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10537 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10538 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010540 Supported in default-server: No
10541
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010542agent-check
10543 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010544 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10545 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10546 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10547 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010548
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010549 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010550 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010551 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10552 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10553 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010554
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010555 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10556 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10557 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10558 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10559 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10560
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010561 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10562 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010563
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010564 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10565 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10566 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010567
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010568 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10569 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10570 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010571
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010572 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10573 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10574 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10575 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10576 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10577 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10578 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010579
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010580 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10581 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010582
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010583 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10584 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10585 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10586 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10587 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10588 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10589 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10590 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10591 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010592
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010593 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10594 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010595 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10596 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10597 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010598 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010599
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010600 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10601 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010602
10603 Supported in default-server: No
10604
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010605agent-send <string>
10606 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10607 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10608 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10609 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10610 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10611
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010612agent-inter <delay>
10613 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10614 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10615
10616 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10617 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10618 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10619 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10620 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10621 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10622 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10623 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10624 of backends use the same servers.
10625
10626 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10627
10628 Supported in default-server: Yes
10629
10630agent-port <port>
10631 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10632
10633 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10634
10635 Supported in default-server: Yes
10636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010637backup
10638 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10639 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10640 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10641 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10642 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10643 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010645 Supported in default-server: No
10646
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010647ca-file <cafile>
10648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10649 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10650 server's certificate.
10651
10652 Supported in default-server: No
10653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010654check
10655 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010656 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10657 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10658 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10659 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10660 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10661 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10662 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010663 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10664 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10665 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010667 Supported in default-server: No
10668
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010669check-send-proxy
10670 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10671 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10672 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10673 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10674 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10675 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10676 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10677
10678 Supported in default-server: No
10679
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010680check-ssl
10681 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10682 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10683 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10684 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010685 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010686 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10687 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10688 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10689 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10690
10691 Supported in default-server: No
10692
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010693ciphers <ciphers>
10694 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010695 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010696 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10697 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10698 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10699 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10700 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10701 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10702
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010703 Supported in default-server: No
10704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010705cookie <value>
10706 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10707 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10708 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10709 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10710 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10711 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10712 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010714 Supported in default-server: No
10715
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010716crl-file <crlfile>
10717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10718 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10719 to verify server's certificate.
10720
10721 Supported in default-server: No
10722
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010723crt <cert>
10724 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10725 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10726 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10727 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10728 certificate request.
10729
10730 Supported in default-server: No
10731
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010732disabled
10733 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10734 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10735 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10736 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10737 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10738
10739 Supported in default-server: No
10740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010741error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010742 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10743 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10744 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010746 Supported in default-server: Yes
10747
10748 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010750fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010751 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10752 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10753 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010755 Supported in default-server: Yes
10756
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010757force-sslv3
10758 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10759 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010760 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10761 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010762
10763 Supported in default-server: No
10764
10765force-tlsv10
10766 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010767 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10768 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010769
10770 Supported in default-server: No
10771
10772force-tlsv11
10773 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010774 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10775 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010776
10777 Supported in default-server: No
10778
10779force-tlsv12
10780 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010781 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10782 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010783
10784 Supported in default-server: No
10785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010786id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010787 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10788 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10789 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010791 Supported in default-server: No
10792
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010793init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10794 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10795 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10796 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10797 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10798 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10799 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10800 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10801 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10802 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10803 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10804 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10805 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10806 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10807 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10808 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10809 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10810 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10811 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10812 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10813 historic behaviour.
10814
10815 Example:
10816 defaults
10817 # never fail on address resolution
10818 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10819
10820 Supported in default-server: Yes
10821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010822inter <delay>
10823fastinter <delay>
10824downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010825 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10826 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10827 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10828 between checks depending on the server state :
10829
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010830 Server state | Interval used
10831 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10832 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10833 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10834 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10835 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10836 or yet unchecked. |
10837 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10838 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10839 | "inter" otherwise.
10840 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010842 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10843 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10844 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10845 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010846 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10847 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10848 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10849 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10850 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010852 Supported in default-server: Yes
10853
10854maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010855 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10856 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10857 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10858 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10859 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10860 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10861 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10862 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010864 Supported in default-server: Yes
10865
10866maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010867 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10868 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10869 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10870 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10871 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10872 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10873 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010875 Supported in default-server: Yes
10876
10877minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010878 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10879 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10880 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10881 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10882 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10883 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010884 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010885 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010887 Supported in default-server: Yes
10888
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010889namespace <name>
10890 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10891 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10892 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10893 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10894
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010895no-ssl-reuse
10896 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10897 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10898 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10899 and for paranoid users.
10900
10901 Supported in default-server: No
10902
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010903no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010904 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10905 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010906 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010907
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010908 Supported in default-server: No
10909
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010910no-tls-tickets
10911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10912 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10913 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010914 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10915 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010916
10917 Supported in default-server: No
10918
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010919no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010920 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010921 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10922 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010923 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10924 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10925 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010926
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010927 Supported in default-server: No
10928
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010929no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010930 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010931 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10932 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010933 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10934 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10935 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010936
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010937 Supported in default-server: No
10938
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010939no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010940 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010941 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10942 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010943 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10944 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10945 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010946
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010947 Supported in default-server: No
10948
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010949non-stick
10950 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10951 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10952 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10953
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010954 Supported in default-server: No
10955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010956observe <mode>
10957 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10958 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10959 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10960 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10961 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10962 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010963 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010965 Supported in default-server: No
10966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010967 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010969on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010970 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10971 Currently, four modes are available:
10972 - fastinter: force fastinter
10973 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10974 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10975 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10976 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010978 Supported in default-server: Yes
10979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010980 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10981
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010982on-marked-down <action>
10983 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10984 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010985 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10986 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10987 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10988 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10989 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10990 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10991 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10992 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010993
10994 Actions are disabled by default
10995
10996 Supported in default-server: Yes
10997
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010998on-marked-up <action>
10999 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11000 Currently one action is available:
11001 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11002 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11003 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11004 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11005 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11006 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11007 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11008 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11009
11010 Actions are disabled by default
11011
11012 Supported in default-server: Yes
11013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011014port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011015 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11016 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11017 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11018 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11019 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11020 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011022 Supported in default-server: Yes
11023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011024redir <prefix>
11025 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11026 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11027 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11028 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11029 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11030 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11031 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11032 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011033 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011034 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11035 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11036 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11037 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11038 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11039
11040 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011042 Supported in default-server: No
11043
11044rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011045 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11046 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11047 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011049 Supported in default-server: Yes
11050
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011051resolve-prefer <family>
11052 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11053 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11054 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11055 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11056
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011057 Default value: ipv6
11058
11059 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011060
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011061 Example:
11062
11063 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011064
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011065resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11066 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11067 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
11068 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
11069 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11070 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11071 configured network, another address is selected.
11072
11073 Supported in default-server: Yes
11074
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011075 Example:
11076
11077 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011078
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011079resolvers <id>
11080 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11081 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011082 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11083 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11084 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11085 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011086
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011087 Supported in default-server: No
11088
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011089 Example:
11090
11091 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011092
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011093 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011094
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011095send-proxy
11096 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11097 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11098 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11099 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011100 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11101 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11102 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11103 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11104 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11105 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11106 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11107 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11108 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11109 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
11110 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
11111 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011112
11113 Supported in default-server: No
11114
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011115send-proxy-v2
11116 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11117 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11118 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11119 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11120 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
11121 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
11122 option of the "bind" keyword.
11123
11124 Supported in default-server: No
11125
11126send-proxy-v2-ssl
11127 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11128 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11129 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11130 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11131 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11132 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11133 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11134 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11135
11136 Supported in default-server: No
11137
11138send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11139 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11140 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11141 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11142 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11143 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11144 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11145 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11146 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11147 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11148
11149 Supported in default-server: No
11150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011151slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011152 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11153 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11154 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11155 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11156 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11157 parameters :
11158
11159 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11160 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11161
11162 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11163 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11164 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11165 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11166
11167 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11168 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11169 seen as failed.
11170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011171 Supported in default-server: Yes
11172
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011173sni <expression>
11174 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11175 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11176 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11177 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11178 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11179
11180 Supported in default-server: no
11181
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011182source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011183source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011184source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011185 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11186 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11187 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11188 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11189
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011190 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11191 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11192 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11193 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11194 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11195 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11196 server.
11197
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011198 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11199 specifying the source address without port(s).
11200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011201 Supported in default-server: No
11202
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011203ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011204 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11205 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11206 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11207 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11208 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11209 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011210 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011211
11212 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011213
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011214tcp-ut <delay>
11215 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11216 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11217 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
11218 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
11219 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11220 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11221 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11222 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11223 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11224 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11225 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11226 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11227 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011229track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011230 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11231 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11232 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11233 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011234 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011236 Supported in default-server: No
11237
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011238verify [none|required]
11239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011240 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11241 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11242 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11243 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011244 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11245 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11246 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011247
11248 Supported in default-server: No
11249
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011250verifyhost <hostname>
11251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11252 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11253 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11254 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11255 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11256 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11257
11258 Supported in default-server: No
11259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011260weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011261 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11262 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11263 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011264 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11265 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11266 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11267 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11268 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11269 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011271 Supported in default-server: Yes
11272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011273
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200112745.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11275-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011276
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011277HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11278using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11279configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011280This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11281can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11282workload.
11283This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11284resolution at run time.
11285Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11286carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11287
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011288Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11289health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11290
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011291
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200112925.3.1. Global overview
11293----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011294
11295As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11296different steps of the process life:
11297
11298 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11299 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11300 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11301
11302 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11303 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11304 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11305
11306A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11307 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11308 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11309 resolution to know this new IP.
11310
11311A few things important to notice:
11312 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11313 first valid response.
11314
11315 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11316 servers return an error.
11317
11318
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113195.3.2. The resolvers section
11320----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011321
11322This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11323HAProxy.
11324There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11325many name servers.
11326
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011327When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11328uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11329is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11330answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11331
11332When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11333used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11334
11335Two types of behavior can be applied:
11336 1. stop DNS resolution
11337 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11338 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11339 1. ANY query type
11340 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11341 server's parameter
11342 3. remaining family type
11343
11344HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11345 - invalid DNS response packet
11346 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11347 - NX domain
11348 - Query refused by server
11349 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11350
11351HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11352 - no Answer records in the response
11353 - DNS response truncated
11354 - Error in DNS response
11355 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11356 - name server timeout
11357
11358For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11359 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11360 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11361 applied;
11362 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11363 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11364 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11365 stops resolution.
11366
11367
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011368resolvers <resolvers id>
11369 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11370
11371A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11372
11373nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11374 DNS server description:
11375 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11376 <ip> : IP address of the server
11377 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11378
11379hold <status> <period>
11380 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11381 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011382 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11383 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011384 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11385 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11386 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11387
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011388 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011389
11390 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11391 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11392 the healch check.
11393
11394resolve_retries <nb>
11395 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11396 giving up.
11397 Default value: 3
11398
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011399 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11400 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11401 type.
11402
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011403timeout <event> <time>
11404 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11405 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11406 events available are:
11407 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11408 been received.
11409 Default value: 1s
11410 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11411 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11412
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011413 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011414
11415 resolvers mydns
11416 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11417 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11418 resolve_retries 3
11419 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011420 hold other 30s
11421 hold refused 30s
11422 hold nx 30s
11423 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011424 hold valid 10s
11425
11426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114276. HTTP header manipulation
11428---------------------------
11429
11430In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11431response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11432request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11433which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011434against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011435
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011436If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11437to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11438but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11439HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11440stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11441because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11442a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11443still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011445This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11446in section 4.2 :
11447
11448 - reqadd <string>
11449 - reqallow <search>
11450 - reqiallow <search>
11451 - reqdel <search>
11452 - reqidel <search>
11453 - reqdeny <search>
11454 - reqideny <search>
11455 - reqpass <search>
11456 - reqipass <search>
11457 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11458 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11459 - reqtarpit <search>
11460 - reqitarpit <search>
11461 - rspadd <string>
11462 - rspdel <search>
11463 - rspidel <search>
11464 - rspdeny <search>
11465 - rspideny <search>
11466 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11467 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11468
11469With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11470is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11471parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11472prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11473Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11474
11475 \t for a tab
11476 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11477 \n for a new line (LF)
11478 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11479 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11480 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11481 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11482 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11483
11484The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11485portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11486above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11487regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
114889 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11489is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11490
11491The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11492after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11493
11494Notes related to these keywords :
11495---------------------------------
11496 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11497 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11498 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11499
11500 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11501 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11502 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11503
11504 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11505 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11506 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11507 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11508 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11509
11510 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11511 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11512 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11513 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11514 useless headers before adding new ones.
11515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011516 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011517 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11518
11519 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11520 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11521 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11522
11523 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11524 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011525 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011526
11527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115287. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11529----------------------------------
11530
11531Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11532client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11533The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11534these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11535but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11536data called patterns.
11537
11538
115397.1. ACL basics
11540---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011541
11542The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11543content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11544from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11545simple :
11546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011547 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011548 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011549 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11550 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011552The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11553adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011554
11555In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011557 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011558
11559This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11560Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11561and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011562an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11563conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11564as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11565are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011566
11567ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11568'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11569which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11570
11571There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11572performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011574The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11575specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11576this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011577methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11578ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011579
11580Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11581 - boolean
11582 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11583 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11584 - string
11585 - data block
11586
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011587Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11588converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11589would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11590The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11591which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11592
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011593Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11594keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11595fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11596which are summarized in the table below :
11597
11598 +---------------------+-----------------+
11599 | Sample or converter | Default |
11600 | output type | matching method |
11601 +---------------------+-----------------+
11602 | boolean | bool |
11603 +---------------------+-----------------+
11604 | integer | int |
11605 +---------------------+-----------------+
11606 | ip | ip |
11607 +---------------------+-----------------+
11608 | string | str |
11609 +---------------------+-----------------+
11610 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11611 +---------------------+-----------------+
11612
11613Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11614matching method, see below.
11615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011616The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11617 - boolean
11618 - integer or integer range
11619 - IP address / network
11620 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11621 - regular expression
11622 - hex block
11623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11625
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011626 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11627 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011628 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011629 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011630 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011631 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011632 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011634The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11635read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11636if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11637lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11638will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11639beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11640a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11641lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11642exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11643
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011644The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11645parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11646ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11647a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11648check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11649
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011650The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11651socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11652file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011654Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11655loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11656
11657 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11658
11659In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11660the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11661case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11662as well.
11663
11664The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11665sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11666do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11667methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11668is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11669obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11670followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11671default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11672that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11673string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11674
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011675The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11676By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11677string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11678resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11679server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11680waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11681flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11682function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011684There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11685sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11686be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011687
11688 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11689 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011690 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11691 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11692 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11693 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011694
11695 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11696 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011697 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011698
11699 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011700 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011701
11702 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011703 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011704
11705 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11706 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11707
11708 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11709 binary or string samples.
11710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011711 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11712 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011714 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11715 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11716 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11719 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011721 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11722 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11725 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011727 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11728 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011729 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011731 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11732 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11733 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011734
11735For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11736request, it is possible to do :
11737
11738 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11739
11740In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11741buffer, one would use the following acl :
11742
11743 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11744
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011745On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11746possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11747
11748 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011750All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11751criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11752method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11753to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11754criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11755the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011757If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011758the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11759For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011761 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11762 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11763 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11764 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011765
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011766
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011767The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11768types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11769combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11770brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11771default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011773 +-------------------------------------------------+
11774 | Input sample type |
11775 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011776 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011777 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11778 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11779 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011780 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011781 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011782 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011783 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011784 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011785 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011786 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011787 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011788 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011789 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011790 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011792 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011793 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011794 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011795 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011796 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011797 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011798 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011799 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011800 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011801 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11802 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11803 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011804
11805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118067.1.1. Matching booleans
11807------------------------
11808
11809In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11810Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11811When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11812that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11813
11814Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11815return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11816"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118197.1.2. Matching integers
11820------------------------
11821
11822Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11823enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11824to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11825
11826Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11827matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11828lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011829
11830For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11831unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11832representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11833
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011834As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11835two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11836instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11837ranges and operators.
11838
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011839For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011840operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11841Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11842of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011844Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011845
11846 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11847 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11848 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11849 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11850 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011852For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011853
11854 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11855
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011856This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11857
11858 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11859
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118617.1.3. Matching strings
11862-----------------------
11863
11864String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11865different forms :
11866
11867 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11868 patterns ;
11869
11870 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11871 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11872
11873 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11874 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11875
11876 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11877 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11878
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011879 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011880 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11881 matches.
11882
11883 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11884 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11885 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011886
11887String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11888exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11889characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11890string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11891to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011892before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011893
11894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118957.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11896---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011897
11898Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11899they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11900possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11901passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11902the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011903the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11904match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011905
11906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119077.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11908-------------------------------------
11909
11910It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11911not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11912a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11913to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11914digits may be used upper or lower case.
11915
11916Example :
11917 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11918 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11919
11920
119217.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11922---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011923
11924IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11925netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11926within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011927host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011928difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11929at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11930does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11931parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011932
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011933The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11934abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11935
11936 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11937 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11938 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11939 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11940 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11941 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11942 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11943 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11944
11945Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11946192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11947
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011948IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11949Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11950trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11951IPv6 patterns.
11952
11953HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11954following situations :
11955 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11956 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11957 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11958 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11959 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11960 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11961 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11962 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11963 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11964 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011966
119677.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11968----------------------------------
11969
11970Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11971combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11972
11973 - AND (implicit)
11974 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11975 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011977A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011979 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011981Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11982indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011984For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11985"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11986requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11987is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11988
11989 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11990 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11991 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11992 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11993
11994To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11995and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11996
11997 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11998 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11999 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12000 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12001
12002 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12003 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12004 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12005 use_backend www if host_www
12006
12007It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12008expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12009be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12010the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12011
12012 The following rule :
12013
12014 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12015 block if METH_POST missing_cl
12016
12017 Can also be written that way :
12018
12019 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
12020
12021It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12022to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12023simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12024sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12025good use is the following :
12026
12027 With named ACLs :
12028
12029 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12030 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12031 monitor fail if site_dead
12032
12033 With anonymous ACLs :
12034
12035 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12036
12037See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
12038
12039
120407.3. Fetching samples
12041---------------------
12042
12043Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12044against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12045sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12046ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12047of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12048available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12049
12050This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12051Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12052compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12053deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12054
12055The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12056matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12057method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12058indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12059
12060As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12061when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12062mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12063the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12064ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12065
12066Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12067multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12068when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12069incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12070are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12071is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12072all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12073
12074Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12075 - name
12076 - name(arg1)
12077 - name(arg1,arg2)
12078
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012079
120807.3.1. Converters
12081-----------------
12082
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012083Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12084of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12085is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12086was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12087has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12088unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12089
12090These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12091sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12092the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12093support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012094
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012095A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12096support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12097supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12098(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12099bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012101The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012102
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012103add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012104 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012105 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012106 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12107 scopes allowed are:
12108 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12109 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12110 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12111 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12112 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012113 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012114
12115and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012116 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012117 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012118 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12119 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12120 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12121 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12122 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12123 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12124 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012125 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012126
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012127base64
12128 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12129 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12130 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12131
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012132bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012133 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012134 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12135 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12136 presence of a flag).
12137
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012138bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12139 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12140 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
12141 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
12142
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012143cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012144 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12145 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012146
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012147crc32([<avalanche>])
12148 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12149 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12150 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12151 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12152 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12153 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12154 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12155 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12156 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12157 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12158 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12159
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012160da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012161 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12162 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12163 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12164 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012165 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012166 configuration language.
12167
12168 Example:
12169 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012170 bind *:8881
12171 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012172 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012173
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012174debug
12175 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12176 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12177 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12178
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012179div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012180 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12181 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012182 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012183 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12184 scope. The scopes allowed are:
12185 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12186 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12187 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12188 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12189 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012190 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012191
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012192djb2([<avalanche>])
12193 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12194 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12195 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12196 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12197 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12198 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12199 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012200 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12201 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012202
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012203even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012204 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012205 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12206
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012207field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12208 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12209 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12210 list of chars.
12211
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012212hex
12213 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12214 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12215 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12216 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012217
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012218http_date([<offset>])
12219 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12220 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12221 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12222 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12223 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12224 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012225
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012226in_table(<table>)
12227 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12228 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12229 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12230 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12231 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12232
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012233ipmask(<mask>)
12234 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12235 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12236 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12237 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12238
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012239json([<input-code>])
12240 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12241 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012242 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012243 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12244 of errors:
12245 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12246 bytes, ...)
12247 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12248 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12249
12250 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12251 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12252 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12253 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12254 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12255 are :
12256 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12257 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12258 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12259 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12260 error ;
12261 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12262 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12263
12264 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12265 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12266
12267 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012268 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012269 capture request header user-agent len 150
12270 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012271
12272 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12273 GET / HTTP/1.0
12274 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12275
12276 Output log:
12277 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12278
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012279language(<value>[,<default>])
12280 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12281 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12282 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12283 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12284 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12285 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12286 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12287 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12288 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12289 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12290 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12291 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012292
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012293 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012294
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012295 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12296 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012297
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012298 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12299 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12300 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12301 use_backend spanish if es
12302 use_backend french if fr
12303 use_backend english if en
12304 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012305
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012306lower
12307 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12308 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12309 type. The result is of type string.
12310
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012311ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12312 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12313 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12314 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12315 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12316 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12317 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12318
12319 Example :
12320
12321 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12322 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12323 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12324
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012325map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12326map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12327map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12328 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12329 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12330 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12331 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12332 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12333 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12334 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12335 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012336
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012337 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12338 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12339 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012340
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012341 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12342 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012343
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012344 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12345 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12346 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12347 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012348 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12349 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012350 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12351 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12352 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12353 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12354 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12355 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12356 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12357 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012358 | | map_reg | |
12359 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12360 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012361 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12362 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12363 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12364 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12365 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012366
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012367 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12368 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12369 the corresponding match text.
12370
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012371 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12372 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12373 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12374 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12375 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012376
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012377 Example :
12378
12379 # this is a comment and is ignored
12380 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12381 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12382 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12383 | | | `---------- value
12384 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12385 | `---------------------------- key
12386 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12387
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012388mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012389 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12390 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012391 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012392 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12393 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12394 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12395 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12396 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12397 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012398 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012399
12400mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012401 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012402 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12403 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012404 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012405 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12406 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12407 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12408 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12409 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12410 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012411 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012412
12413neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012414 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12415 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12416 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12417 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012418
12419not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012420 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012421 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12422 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12423 absence of a flag).
12424
12425odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012426 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012427 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12428
12429or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012430 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012431 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012432 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12433 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12434 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12435 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12436 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12437 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12438 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012439 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012440
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012441regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012442 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12443 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12444 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12445 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12446 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12447 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12448 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12449 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12450 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12451 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012452 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12453 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12454 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12455 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012456
12457 Example :
12458
12459 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12460 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12461 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12462 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12463
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012464capture-req(<id>)
12465 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12466 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12467
12468 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012469 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12470 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012471
12472capture-res(<id>)
12473 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12474 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12475
12476 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012477 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12478 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012479
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012480sdbm([<avalanche>])
12481 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12482 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12483 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12484 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12485 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12486 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12487 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012488 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12489 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012490
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012491set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012492 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12493 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12494 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12495 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12496 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012497 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012498 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12499 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012500 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12501 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12502
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012503sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012504 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12505 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012506 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012507 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12508 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12509 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12510 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012511 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012512 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12513 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012514 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12515 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012516
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012517table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12518 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12519 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12520 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12521 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12522 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12523 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12524
12525
12526table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12527 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12528 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12529 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12530 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12531 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12532 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12533
12534table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12535 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12536 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12537 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12538 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12539 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12540
12541table_conn_cur(<table>)
12542 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12543 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12544 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12545 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12546 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12547
12548table_conn_rate(<table>)
12549 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12550 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12551 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12552 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12553 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12554
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012555table_gpt0(<table>)
12556 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12557 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12558 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12559 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12560 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12561
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012562table_gpc0(<table>)
12563 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12564 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12565 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12566 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12567 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12568
12569table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12570 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12571 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12572 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12573 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12574 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12575 sample fetch keyword.
12576
12577table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12578 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12579 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12580 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12581 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12582 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12583
12584table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12585 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12586 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12587 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12588 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12589 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12590 keyword.
12591
12592table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12593 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12594 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12595 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12596 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12597 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12598
12599table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12600 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12601 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12602 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12603 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12604 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12605 keyword.
12606
12607table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12608 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12609 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12610 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12611 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12612 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12613 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12614 keyword.
12615
12616table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12617 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12618 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12619 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12620 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12621 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12622 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12623 keyword.
12624
12625table_server_id(<table>)
12626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12628 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12629 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12630 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12631 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12632
12633table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12634 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12635 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12636 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12637 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12638 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12639 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12640 keyword.
12641
12642table_sess_rate(<table>)
12643 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12644 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12645 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12646 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12647 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12648 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12649 keyword.
12650
12651table_trackers(<table>)
12652 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12653 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12654 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12655 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12656 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12657 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12658 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12659 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12660 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12661 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12662
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012663upper
12664 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12665 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12666 type. The result is of type string.
12667
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012668url_dec
12669 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12670 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12671
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012672utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12673 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12674 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12675 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12676 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12677 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12678 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12679
12680 Example :
12681
12682 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12683 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12684 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12685
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012686word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12687 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12688 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12689
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012690wt6([<avalanche>])
12691 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12692 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12693 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12694 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12695 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12696 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12697 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012698 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12699 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012700
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012701xor(<value>)
12702 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012703 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012704 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012705 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12706 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12707 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012708 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012709 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12710 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012711 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12712 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012713
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012714
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200127157.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012716--------------------------------------------
12717
12718A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12719not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12720"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12721The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12722
12723always_false : boolean
12724 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12725 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12726
12727always_true : boolean
12728 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12729 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12730
12731avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012732 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012733 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12734 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12735 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12736 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12737 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12738 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12739 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12740 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12741 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12742 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12743 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12744 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12745 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012748 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12749 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12750 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12751 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12752 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012754be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12756 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12757 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12758 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12759 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12760 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012761
12762 Example :
12763 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12764 backend dynamic
12765 mode http
12766 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12767 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012768
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012769bin(<hexa>) : bin
12770 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12771 of the string.
12772
12773bool(<bool>) : bool
12774 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12775 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012777connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12778 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012779 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012780 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12781 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012782
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012783 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012784 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012785 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012787 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12788 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012789
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012790 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012791 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012792 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012793 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12794 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012796 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012797
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012798 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12799 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012800 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012801 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012802
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012803date([<offset>]) : integer
12804 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12805 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12806 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12807 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012808 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12809
12810 Example :
12811
12812 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12813 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012814
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012815env(<name>) : string
12816 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12817 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12818 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12819 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12820 certain way.
12821
12822 Examples :
12823 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12824 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12825
12826 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12827 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12830 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012831 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12832 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12834 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12835 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12836 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12837 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012838
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020012839fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12840 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
12841 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
12842 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
12843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12845 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12846 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12847 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12848 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12849 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12850 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12851 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12852 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012853
12854 Example :
12855 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12856 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12857 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12858 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12859 frontend mail
12860 bind :25
12861 mode tcp
12862 maxconn 100
12863 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12864 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12865 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12866 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012867
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012868int(<integer>) : signed integer
12869 Returns a signed integer.
12870
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012871ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12872 Returns an ipv4.
12873
12874ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12875 Returns an ipv6.
12876
12877meth(<method>) : method
12878 Returns a method.
12879
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012880nbproc : integer
12881 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12882 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12883 and debugging purposes.
12884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012885nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12886 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12887 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12888 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012889 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12890 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12891 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012892
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012893proc : integer
12894 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12895 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12896 debugging purposes.
12897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012898queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012899 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12900 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12901 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012902 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12903 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12904 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12905 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12906 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12907
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012908rand([<range>]) : integer
12909 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12910 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12911 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12912 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12913 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12916 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12917 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12918 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12919 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12920 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12921 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12922 methods.
12923
12924srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12925 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12926 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12927 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12928 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12929 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12930 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12931 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12932
12933srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12934 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12935 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012936 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012937 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12938 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12939 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12940 overloading servers).
12941
12942 Example :
12943 # Redirect to a separate back
12944 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12945 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12946 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12947
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012948stopping : boolean
12949 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12950 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12951 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12952
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012953str(<string>) : string
12954 Returns a string.
12955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012956table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12957 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12958 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12959
12960table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12961 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12962 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12963 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12964
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012965var(<var-name>) : undefined
12966 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012967 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12968 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12969 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12970 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012971 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012972 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12973 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012974 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12975 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129777.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012978----------------------------------
12979
12980The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12981closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12982methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12983sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12984TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012985the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12986counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12987"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012988argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12989the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12990this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012991
12992be_id : integer
12993 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12994 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12995
12996dst : ip
12997 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12998 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12999 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13000 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13001 RFC 4291.
13002
13003dst_conn : integer
13004 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13005 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13006 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13007 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13008 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13009 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13010 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13011 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013012
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013013dst_is_local : boolean
13014 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13015 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13016 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13017 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13018 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13019 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13020 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13021 it only once per connection.
13022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013023dst_port : integer
13024 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13025 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13026 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13027 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13028 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13029 an HTTP header.
13030
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013031fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13032 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13033 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13034 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13035 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13036 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13037 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13038
13039fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13040 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13041 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13042 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13043 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13044 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13045 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13046
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013047fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13048 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13049 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13050 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13051 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13052
13053fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13054 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13055 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13056 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13057 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13058
13059fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13060 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13061 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13062 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13063 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13064
13065fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13066 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13067 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13068 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13069 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13070
13071fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13072 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13073 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13074 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13075 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13076
13077fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13078 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13079 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13080 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13081 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013083fe_id : integer
13084 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
13085 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
13086 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13087
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013088sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013089sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13090sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13091sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013092 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13093 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13094 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13095
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013096sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013097sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13098sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13099sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013100 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13101 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13102 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013104sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013105sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13106sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13107sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013108 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13109 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013110 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13111 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13112 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013113
13114 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13115 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013116 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13117 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13118 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013119 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13120 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13121
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013122sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013123sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13124sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13125sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013126 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13127 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13128
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013129sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013130sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13131sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13132sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013133 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13134 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13135 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13136
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013137sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013138sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13139sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13140sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013141 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13142 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13143 See also src_conn_rate.
13144
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013145sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013146sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13147sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13148sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013149 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013150 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013151
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013152sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13153sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13154sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13155sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13156 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13157 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13158
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013159sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013160sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13161sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13162sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013163 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13164 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13165 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013166 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13167 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13168 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013169
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013170sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013171sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13172sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13173sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013174 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13175 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13176 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13177
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013178sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013179sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13180sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13181sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013182 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13183 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13184 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13185 src_http_err_rate.
13186
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013187sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013188sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13189sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13190sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013191 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13192 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13193 src_http_req_cnt.
13194
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013195sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013196sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13197sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13198sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013199 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13200 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13201 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13202 src_http_req_rate.
13203
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013204sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013205sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13206sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13207sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013208 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013209 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13210 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13211 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13212 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013213
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013214 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13215 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013216 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13217
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013218sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013219sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13220sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13221sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013222 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13223 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13224 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013225
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013226sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013227sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13228sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13229sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013230 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13231 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13232 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013233
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013234sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013235sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13236sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13237sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013238 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13239 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13240 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13241 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013242 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013243 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13244
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013245sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013246sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13247sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13248sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013249 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13250 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13251 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13252 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13253 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013254 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013255
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013256sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013257sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13258sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13259sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013260 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13261 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13262 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013264sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013265sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13266sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13267sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013268 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13269 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013270 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013271 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13272 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013273 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13274 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13275 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277so_id : integer
13278 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13279 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13280 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013282src : ip
13283 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13284 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13285 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13286 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013287 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13288 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13289 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13290 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013291
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013292 Example:
13293 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13294 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13297 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13298 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13299 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013300 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13303 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13304 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013305 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013306 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13309 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13310 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13311 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13312 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13313 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13314 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013315
13316 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13317 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13318 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13319 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013320 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013321 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13322 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013324src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013325 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013326 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013327 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013328 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013330src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013331 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013332 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13333 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013334 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013336src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13337 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13338 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13339 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013340 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013342src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013343 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013345 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013346 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013347
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013348src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13349 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13350 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13351 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13352 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013354src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013355 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013356 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013357 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13358 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013359 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13360 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13361 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013363src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13364 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13365 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013366 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013367 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013368 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13371 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13372 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13373 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13374 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013375 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13378 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13379 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13380 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013381 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13384 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13385 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13386 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013387 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013388 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13391 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13392 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13393 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013394 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013395 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13396 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013397
13398 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013399 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013400 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013401
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013402src_is_local : boolean
13403 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13404 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13405 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13406 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13407 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13408 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13409 once per connection.
13410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013412 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13413 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13414 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13415 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13416 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013418src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013419 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13420 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13421 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13422 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13423 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013425src_port : integer
13426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13427 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13428 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13429 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13432 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013433 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13434 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13435 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013436 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013438src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13439 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13440 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13441 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13442 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013443 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13446 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13447 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13448 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13449 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13450 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13451 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13452 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13453 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013454
13455 Example :
13456 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13457 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13458 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13459 listen ssh
13460 bind :22
13461 mode tcp
13462 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013463 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013464 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013465 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467srv_id : integer
13468 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13469 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13470 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013471
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134727.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013475The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13476closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13477when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13478usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013479future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013480
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013481ssl_bc : boolean
13482 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13483 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13484 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13485
13486ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13487 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13488 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13489
13490ssl_bc_cipher : string
13491 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13492 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13493
13494ssl_bc_protocol : string
13495 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13496 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13497
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013498ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013499 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013500 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13501 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013502
13503ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13504 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13505 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13506 if session was reused or not.
13507
13508ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13509 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13510 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013512ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13513 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13514 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13515 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13516 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13517 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013519ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13520 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13521 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13522 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13523 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013524
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013525ssl_c_der : binary
13526 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13527 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13528 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013530ssl_c_err : integer
13531 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13532 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13533 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13534 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13535 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13538 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13539 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13540 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13541 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13542 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13543 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13544 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13545 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013547ssl_c_key_alg : string
13548 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13549 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13550 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013552ssl_c_notafter : string
13553 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13554 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13555 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013557ssl_c_notbefore : string
13558 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13559 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13560 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013562ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13563 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13564 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13565 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13566 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13567 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13568 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13569 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13570 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013572ssl_c_serial : binary
13573 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13574 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13575 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013577ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13578 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13579 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13580 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013581 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13582 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13583
13584 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013586ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13587 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13588 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13589 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013591ssl_c_used : boolean
13592 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13593 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013595ssl_c_verify : integer
13596 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13597 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13598 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13599 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013601ssl_c_version : integer
13602 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13603 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013604
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013605ssl_f_der : binary
13606 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13607 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13608 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013610ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13611 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13612 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13613 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13614 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013615 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13617 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13618 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013620ssl_f_key_alg : string
13621 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13622 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13623 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625ssl_f_notafter : string
13626 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13627 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13628 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013630ssl_f_notbefore : string
13631 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13632 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13633 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13636 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13637 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13638 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13639 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13640 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13641 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13642 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13643 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645ssl_f_serial : binary
13646 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13647 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13648 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013649
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013650ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13651 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13652 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13653 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013655ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13656 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13657 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13658 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013660ssl_f_version : integer
13661 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13662 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13663
13664ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013665 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13666 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13667 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013669 Example :
13670 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13671 listen http-https
13672 bind :80
13673 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13674 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13675
13676ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13677 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13678 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13679
13680ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013681 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013682 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13683 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13684 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13685 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13686 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13687 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13688 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13689 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013691ssl_fc_cipher : string
13692 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13693 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013695ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013696 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13697 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013698 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13699 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13700 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13701 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013703ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13704 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013705 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13706 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13707 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13708 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013709
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013710ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013711 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13712 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013715 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013716 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13717 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13718 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13719 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13720 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13721 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13722 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013724ssl_fc_protocol : string
13725 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13726 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013727
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013728ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013729 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013730 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13731 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013733ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13734 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13735 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13736 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13737 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013739ssl_fc_sni : string
13740 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13741 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13742 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13743 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13744 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13745
13746 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13747 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13748 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013749 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13750 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013753 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13754 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013756ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13757 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13758 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013759
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013760
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137617.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013762------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013764Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13765sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13766only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13767For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13768be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13769can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13770sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13771for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13772content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13775 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13776 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13777 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013779payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13780 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13781 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13782 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013784req.len : integer
13785req_len : integer (deprecated)
13786 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13787 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13788 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13789 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13790 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13791 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13792 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13793 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013795req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13796 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013797 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13798 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13799 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13800 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013802 ACL alternatives :
13803 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013805req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13806 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13807 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13808 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13809 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811 ACL alternatives :
13812 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013814 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013816req.proto_http : boolean
13817req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13818 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13819 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13820 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13821 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13822 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13823 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13824 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013826 Example:
13827 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13828 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13829 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013830 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013832req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13833rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13834 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13835 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13836 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13837 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13838 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13839 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13840 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013842 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13843 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13844 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13845 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13846 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13847 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013849 ACL derivatives :
13850 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013852 Example :
13853 listen tse-farm
13854 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13855 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13856 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13857 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13858 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13859 persist rdp-cookie
13860 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13861 # This is only useful makes sense if
13862 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13863 stick-table type string size 204800
13864 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13865 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13866 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013868 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13869 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013871req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13872rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13873 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13874 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13875 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13876 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013878 ACL derivatives :
13879 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013880
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013881req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13882 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13883 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013884 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13885 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13886 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13887 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13888 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13891req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13892 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13893 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13894 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13895 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13896 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13897 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13898 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013900req.ssl_sni : string
13901req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13902 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13903 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13904 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13905 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13906 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13907 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13908 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13909 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13910 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13911 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13912 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13913 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013915 ACL derivatives :
13916 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013918 Examples :
13919 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13920 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13921 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13922 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13923 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013924
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013925req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13926 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13927 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13928 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13929 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13930 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13931 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13932 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13933 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13934 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013936req.ssl_ver : integer
13937req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13938 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13939 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13940 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13941 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13942 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13943 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13944 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13945 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13946 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013948 ACL derivatives :
13949 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013950
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013951res.len : integer
13952 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13953 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13954 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13955 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13956 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13957 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13958 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13959 content inspection.
13960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013961res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13962 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013963 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13964 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13965 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13966 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013968res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13969 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13970 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13971 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13972 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013975
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013976res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13977rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13978 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13979 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13980 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13981 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13982 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13983 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13984 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013986wait_end : boolean
13987 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13988 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13989 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13990 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13991 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13992 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13993 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13994 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996 Examples :
13997 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13998 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13999 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14002 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14003 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14004 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14005 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14006 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14007 tcp-request content reject
14008
14009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140107.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011--------------------------------------
14012
14013It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14014This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14015data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14016its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14017HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14018content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14019to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14020more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14021response are indexed.
14022
14023base : string
14024 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14025 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14026 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14027 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14028 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14029 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14030 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14031 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14032
14033 ACL derivatives :
14034 base : exact string match
14035 base_beg : prefix match
14036 base_dir : subdir match
14037 base_dom : domain match
14038 base_end : suffix match
14039 base_len : length match
14040 base_reg : regex match
14041 base_sub : substring match
14042
14043base32 : integer
14044 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14045 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14046 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014047 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14048 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14049 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014050
14051base32+src : binary
14052 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14053 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14054 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14055 per-URL counters.
14056
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014057capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14058 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14059 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14060 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14061
14062capture.req.method : string
14063 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14064 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14065 because it's allocated.
14066
14067capture.req.uri : string
14068 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14069 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14070 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14071 allocated.
14072
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014073capture.req.ver : string
14074 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14075 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14076 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14077
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014078capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14079 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14080 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14081 The first entry is an index of 0.
14082 See also: "capture response header"
14083
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014084capture.res.ver : string
14085 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14086 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14087 persistent flag.
14088
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014089req.body : binary
14090 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14091 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14092 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14093 the first chunk is analyzed.
14094
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014095req.body_param([<name>) : string
14096 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14097 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14098 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14099 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14100 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14101 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14102 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14103 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14104 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14105 given.
14106
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014107req.body_len : integer
14108 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14109 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14110 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14111 "option http-buffer-request".
14112
14113req.body_size : integer
14114 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14115 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14116 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14117 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14118 "option http-buffer-request".
14119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014120req.cook([<name>]) : string
14121cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14122 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14123 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14124 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14125 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14126 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14127 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14128 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14129 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14130
14131 ACL derivatives :
14132 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14133 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14134 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14135 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14136 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14137 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14138 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14139 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014141req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14142cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14143 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14144 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014146req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14147cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14148 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14149 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14150 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14151 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014153cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14154 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14155 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14156 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14157 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014158 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014159 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14160 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14161 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14162 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014164hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14165 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14166 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14167 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14168 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014169 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014171req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14172 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14173 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14174 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14175 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14176 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14177 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14178 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14179 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14182 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14183 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14184 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14185 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014187req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14188 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14189 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14190 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14191 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14192 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14193 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14194 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14195 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14196 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14197 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14198 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014200 ACL derivatives :
14201 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14202 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14203 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14204 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14205 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14206 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14207 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14208 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14209
14210req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14211hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14212 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14213 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14214 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14215 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14216 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14217 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14218 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14219 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14220 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14221
14222req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14223hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14224 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14225 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14226 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14227 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14228 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14229 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14230 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14231 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14232
14233req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14234hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14235 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14236 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14237 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14238 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14239 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14240 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14241 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14242
14243http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14244 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14245 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14246 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14247 basic auth is supported.
14248
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014249http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14250 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14251 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14252 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14253 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14255 basic auth is supported.
14256
14257 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014258 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14259 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14260 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14261 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262
14263http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014264 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14265 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014266 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14267 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014269method : integer + string
14270 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14271 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14272 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14273 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14274 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14275 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14276 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278 ACL derivatives :
14279 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014281 Example :
14282 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14283 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14284 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014286path : string
14287 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14288 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14289 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14290 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14291 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14292 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14293 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014295 ACL derivatives :
14296 path : exact string match
14297 path_beg : prefix match
14298 path_dir : subdir match
14299 path_dom : domain match
14300 path_end : suffix match
14301 path_len : length match
14302 path_reg : regex match
14303 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014304
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014305query : string
14306 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14307 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14308 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14309 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
14310 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
14311 which stops before the question mark.
14312
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014313req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14314 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14315 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14316 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14317 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014319req.ver : string
14320req_ver : string (deprecated)
14321 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14322 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14323 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325 ACL derivatives :
14326 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328res.comp : boolean
14329 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14330 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14331 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014333res.comp_algo : string
14334 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14335 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14336 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338res.cook([<name>]) : string
14339scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14340 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14341 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14342 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014344 ACL derivatives :
14345 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014347res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14348scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14349 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14350 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14351 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14354scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14355 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14356 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14357 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14360 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14361 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14362 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14363 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14364 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14365 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14366 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14367 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14368 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014370res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14371 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14372 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14373 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14374 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14375 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14378shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14379 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14380 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14381 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14382 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14383 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14384 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14385 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14386 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014388 ACL derivatives :
14389 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14390 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14391 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14392 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14393 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14394 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14395 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14396 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14397
14398res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14399shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14400 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14401 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14402 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14403 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14404 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14407shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14408 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14409 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14410 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14411 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14412 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14413 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014414
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014415res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14416 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14417 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14418 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14419 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014421res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14422shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14423 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14424 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14425 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14426 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14427 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14428 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014430res.ver : string
14431resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14432 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14433 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435 ACL derivatives :
14436 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014438set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14439 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14440 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014441 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014442 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014444 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14445 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447status : integer
14448 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14449 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14450 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014451
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014452unique-id : string
14453 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14454 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14455 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14456 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14457 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14458 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014460url : string
14461 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14462 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14463 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14464 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14465 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14466 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14467 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014469 ACL derivatives :
14470 url : exact string match
14471 url_beg : prefix match
14472 url_dir : subdir match
14473 url_dom : domain match
14474 url_end : suffix match
14475 url_len : length match
14476 url_reg : regex match
14477 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014479url_ip : ip
14480 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14481 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14482 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14483 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14484 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14485 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14486 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488url_port : integer
14489 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14490 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14491 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14492 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014493
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014494urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14495url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14497 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014498 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14499 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14500 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14501 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014502 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14503 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014504 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14505 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014507 ACL derivatives :
14508 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14509 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14510 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14511 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14512 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14513 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14514 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14515 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014516
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014518 Example :
14519 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14520 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14521 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14522 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014523
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014524urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14526 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14527 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014528
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014529url32 : integer
14530 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14531 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14532 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14533 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14534 is an unsigned integer.
14535
14536url32+src : binary
14537 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14538 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14539 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14540
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145427.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014543---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014545Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14546every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014547order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014549ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14550---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014551FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014552HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014553HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14554HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014555HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14556HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14557HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14558HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14559LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014560METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014561METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014562METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14563METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14564METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14565METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014566METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014567METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014568RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014569REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014570TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014571WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14572---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014573
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145758. Logging
14576----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014577
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014578One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14579provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14580very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14581provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14582state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014583to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014584headers.
14585
14586In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14587about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14588send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14589
14590 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14591 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14592 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14593 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14594 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014595 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14596 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014597
14598The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14599allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14600as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14601while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14602real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14603delay.
14604
14605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146068.1. Log levels
14607---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014608
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014609TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014610source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014611HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14612in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14613track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14614syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14615about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014616
14617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146188.2. Log formats
14619----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014620
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014621HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014622and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14623slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14624options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014625
14626 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14627 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14628 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14629 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14630 extents.
14631
14632 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14633 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14634 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14635 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14636 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14637
14638 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14639 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14640 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14641 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14642 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14643
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014644 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14645 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14646 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14647 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14648
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014649 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14650
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014651Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14652specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14653field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14654servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14655always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14656identifier.
14657
14658Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14659 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14660 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14661 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14662 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14663
14664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146658.2.1. Default log format
14666-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014667
14668This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14669as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14670format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14671
14672 Example :
14673 listen www
14674 mode http
14675 log global
14676 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14677
14678 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14679 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14680 (www/HTTP)
14681
14682 Field Format Extract from the example above
14683 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14684 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14685 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14686 4 'to' to
14687 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14688 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14689
14690Detailed fields description :
14691 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14692 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14693 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14694 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14695 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14696 and processed the connection.
14697 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14698
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014699In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14700"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14701connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14702
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014703It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14704will eventually disappear.
14705
14706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147078.2.2. TCP log format
14708---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014709
14710The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14711is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14712information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14713counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14714emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14715environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14716the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14717sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014718specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14719not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14720fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14721marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014722
14723 Example :
14724 frontend fnt
14725 mode tcp
14726 option tcplog
14727 log global
14728 default_backend bck
14729
14730 backend bck
14731 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14732
14733 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14734 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14735 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14736
14737 Field Format Extract from the example above
14738 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14739 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14740 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14741 4 frontend_name fnt
14742 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14743 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14744 7 bytes_read* 212
14745 8 termination_state --
14746 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14747 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14748
14749Detailed fields description :
14750 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014751 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14752 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14753 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014754 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14755 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14756 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014757
14758 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014759 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14760 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14761 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014762
14763 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14764 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14765 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14766 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14767
14768 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14769 and processed the connection.
14770
14771 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14772 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14773 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14774 applications.
14775
14776 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14777 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14778 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14779 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14780 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14781
14782 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14783 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14784 See "Timers" below for more details.
14785
14786 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14787 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14788 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14789 "Timers" below for more details.
14790
14791 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014792 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014793 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14794 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14795 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14796 details.
14797
14798 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14799 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14800 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14801 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14802 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14803
14804 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14805 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14806 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14807 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14808 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14809 for more details.
14810
14811 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014812 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014813 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14814 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14815 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014816 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014817
14818 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14819 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14820 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14821 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14822 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14823 caused by a denial of service attack.
14824
14825 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14826 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14827 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14828 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14829 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14830 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14831 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14832 denial of service attack.
14833
14834 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14835 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14836 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14837 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14838 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14839 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14840 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14841 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14842 be processed than on other servers.
14843
14844 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14845 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14846 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14847 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14848 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14849 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14850 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14851 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14852 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14853 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14854 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14855 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14856 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14857
14858 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14859 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14860 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14861 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14862 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14863 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14864 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14865 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14866
14867 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14868 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14869 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14870 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14871 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14872 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14873 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14874 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14875 occurs.
14876
14877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148788.2.3. HTTP log format
14879----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014880
14881The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14882is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14883the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14884are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14885emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14886generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14887"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14888which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014889frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14890is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014891
14892Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14893slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14894with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14895
14896 Example :
14897 frontend http-in
14898 mode http
14899 option httplog
14900 log global
14901 default_backend bck
14902
14903 backend static
14904 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14905
14906 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14907 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14908 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014909 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014910
14911 Field Format Extract from the example above
14912 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14913 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014914 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014915 4 frontend_name http-in
14916 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014917 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014918 7 status_code 200
14919 8 bytes_read* 2750
14920 9 captured_request_cookie -
14921 10 captured_response_cookie -
14922 11 termination_state ----
14923 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14924 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14925 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14926 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14927 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014929Detailed fields description :
14930 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014931 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14932 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14933 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014934 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14935 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14936 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014937
14938 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014939 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14940 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14941 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014942
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014943 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
14944 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014945
14946 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14947 and processed the connection.
14948
14949 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14950 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14951 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14952
14953 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14954 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14955 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14956 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14957 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14958 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14959
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014960 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
14961 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
14962 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
14963 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
14964 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
14965 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
14966 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014967
14968 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14969 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14970 See "Timers" below for more details.
14971
14972 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14973 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14974 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14975 below for more details.
14976
14977 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14978 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14979 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14980 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14981 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14982 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14983 for more details.
14984
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014985 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
14986 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
14987 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
14988 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
14989 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
14990 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
14991 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
14992 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014993
14994 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14995 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14996 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14997
14998 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14999 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15000 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15001 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15002 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15003 overflowing.
15004
15005 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15006 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15007 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15008 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15009 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15010 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15011 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15012 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15013
15014 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15015 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15016 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15017 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15018 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15019 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15020 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15021 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15022
15023 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15024 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15025 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15026 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15027 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15028 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15029 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15030
15031 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015032 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015033 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15034 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15035 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015036 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015037 system.
15038
15039 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15040 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15041 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15042 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15043 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15044 caused by a denial of service attack.
15045
15046 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15047 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15048 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15049 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15050 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15051 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15052 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15053 denial of service attack.
15054
15055 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15056 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15057 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15058 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15059 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15060 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15061 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15062 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15063 processed than on other servers.
15064
15065 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15066 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15067 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15068 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15069 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15070 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15071 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15072 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15073 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15074 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15075 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15076 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15077 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15078
15079 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15080 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15081 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15082 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15083 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15084 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15085 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15086 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15087
15088 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15089 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15090 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15091 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15092 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15093 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15094 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15095 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15096 occurs.
15097
15098 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15099 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15100 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15101 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15102 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15103 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15104 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15105 cookies" below for more details.
15106
15107 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15108 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15109 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15110 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15111 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15112 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15113 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15114 and cookies" below for more details.
15115
15116 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15117 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15118 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15119 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15120 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15121 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15122 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15123 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15124
15125
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200151268.2.4. Custom log format
15127------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015128
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015129The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015130mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015131
15132HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15133Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15134separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15135prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15136
15137Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15138variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015139("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015140
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015141If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015142as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015143less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15144the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15145
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015146Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015147In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015148in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015149
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015150Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15151'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15152https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15153such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15154
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015155Flags are :
15156 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015157 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015158 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15159 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015160
15161 Example:
15162
15163 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15164 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15165
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015166 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15167
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015168At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15169
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015170 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15171 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015172
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015173the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015174
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015175 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15176 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15177 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015178
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015179and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15180
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015181 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15182 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015183
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015184Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15185
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015186 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015187 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015188 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15189 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15190 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015191 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15192 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15193 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015194 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015195 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15196 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015197 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015198 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15199 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015200 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015201 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015202 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015203 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015204 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015205 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015206 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015207 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15208 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15209 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15210 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15211 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015212 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015213 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15214 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015215 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015216 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15217 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015218 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15219 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15220 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015221 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015222 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15223 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015224 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015225 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15226 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15227 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015228 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015229 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015230 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15231 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15232 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15233 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015234 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015235 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015236 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015237 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015238 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015239 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015240 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15241 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15242 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015243 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015244 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15245 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015246 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015247 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15248 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15249 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015250 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015251 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015252 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015253
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015254 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015255
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015256
152578.2.5. Error log format
15258-----------------------
15259
15260When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15261protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15262By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15263"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15264will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15265logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15266
15267The format looks like this :
15268
15269 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15270 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15271 Connection error during SSL handshake
15272
15273 Field Format Extract from the example above
15274 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15275 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15276 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15277 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15278 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15279
15280These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15281failures.
15282
15283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152848.3. Advanced logging options
15285-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015286
15287Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15288just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15289options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15290for more information about their usage.
15291
15292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152938.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15294------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015295
15296It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15297haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15298commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15299monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15300ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15301
15302 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15303 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15304 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15305 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15306
15307 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15308 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15309 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015310 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015311 such as other load-balancers.
15312
15313 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15314 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15315 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15316
15317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153188.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15319----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015320
15321The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15322what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15323or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15324"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15325just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15326log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15327after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15328is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15329with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15330with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15331
15332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153338.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15334------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015335
15336Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15337for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15338"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15339retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15340raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15341a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15342file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15343you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15344"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15345
15346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153478.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15348--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015349
15350Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15351multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15352them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15353"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15354logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15355error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15356and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15357too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15358useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15359alternative.
15360
15361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153628.4. Timing events
15363------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015364
15365Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15366reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15367the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15368frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015369mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15370addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15371
15372 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15373 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15374 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15375 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15376 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15377 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15378 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015379
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015380 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15381 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15382 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15383 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15384 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15385 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15386 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15387 nothing was received on the connection.
15388
15389 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15390 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15391 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15392 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15393 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15394 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15395 request typed by hand during a test.
15396
15397 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15398 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15399 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15400 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15401 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15402 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15403 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015404
15405 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15406 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15407 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15408 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15409 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15410
15411 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15412 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15413 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15414 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15415 connection never established.
15416
15417 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15418 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15419 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15420 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15421 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15422 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15423 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15424 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15425 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15426 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15427 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15428
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015429 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15430 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15431 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15432 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15433 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15434 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15435
15436 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15437
15438 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15439 "Ta" can never be negative.
15440
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015441 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15442 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015443 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15444 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015445 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015446
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015447 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015448
15449 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015450 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15451 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015452
15453These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15454protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15455that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015456due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15457"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15458that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015459
15460Most common cases :
15461
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015462 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15463 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15464 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15465 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15466 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15467 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15468 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15469 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15470 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15471 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15472 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015473 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015474
15475 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15476 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15477 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15478 of ms on remote networks.
15479
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015480 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15481 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15482 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015483
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015484 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15485 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15486 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15487 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15488 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15489 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15490 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15491 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15492 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015493
15494Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15495
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015496 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015497 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015498 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015499
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015500 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015501 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15502 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15503
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015504 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015505 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15506 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15507 flags.
15508
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015509 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15510 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015511 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15512 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15513 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15514 the client connection was maintained open.
15515
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015516 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015517 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015518 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015519 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15520
15521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155228.5. Session state at disconnection
15523-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015524
15525TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15526"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
155272-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15528each of which has a special meaning :
15529
15530 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15531 session to terminate :
15532
15533 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15534
15535 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15536 server explicitly refused it.
15537
15538 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15539 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15540 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15541 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015542 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15543
15544 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15545 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015546
15547 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15548 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15549 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15550 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15551 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15552
15553 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15554 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15555 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15556 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15557 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15558
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015559 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15560 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15561
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015562 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15563 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15564 backup connections when going up.
15565
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015566 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15567
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015568 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15569 send or receive data.
15570
15571 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15572 send or receive data.
15573
15574 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15575 with nothing left in the buffers.
15576
15577 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15578
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015579 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015580 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15581
15582 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15583 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15584 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15585 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15586 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15587
15588 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15589 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15590
15591 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15592 server (HTTP only).
15593
15594 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15595
15596 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15597 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15598 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15599
15600 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15601 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15602 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15603
15604 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15605
15606 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15607 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15608
15609 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15610 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15611 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15612
15613 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15614 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015615 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15616 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015617
15618 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15619 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15620 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15621 another server.
15622
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015623 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015624 server.
15625
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015626 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15627 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15628 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15629 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15630
15631 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15632 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15633 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15634 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15635
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015636 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15637 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15638 "use-server" rule).
15639
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015640 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15641
15642 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15643 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15644
15645 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15646
15647 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15648 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15649 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15650
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015651 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15652 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015653 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015654 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15655 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15656
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015657 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15658
15659 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15660 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15661
15662 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15663
15664 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15665
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015666The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15667was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015668helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15669starvation, attacks, etc...
15670
15671The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15672alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15673easier finding and understanding.
15674
15675 Flags Reason
15676
15677 -- Normal termination.
15678
15679 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15680 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15681 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15682 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15683
15684 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15685 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15686 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15687 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15688 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15689 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015690
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015691 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15692 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015693 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015694
15695 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15696 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15697 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15698
15699 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15700 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15701 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15702 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15703 the server takes too long to respond.
15704
15705 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15706 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15707 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15708 long a time to respond.
15709
15710 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15711 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15712 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15713 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015714 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15715 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015716
15717 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15718 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15719 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15720 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15721 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015722 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015723 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15724 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15725 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15726 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15727 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15728 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15729 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15730 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15731 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15732 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15733 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15734 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015735
15736 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15737 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015738 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15739 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15740 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15741 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015742
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015743 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15744 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015746 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015747 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15748 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15749 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15750 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15751 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15752
15753 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15754 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15755 503 or 504 here.
15756
15757 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15758 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15759 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15760 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15761 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15762
15763 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15764 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015765 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015766 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15767 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15768
15769 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15770 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15771 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15772 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15773 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15774 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15775 between haproxy and the server.
15776
15777 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15778 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15779 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15780 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15781 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15782 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15783 solution is to fix the application.
15784
15785 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15786 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15787 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15788 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15789 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15790 external attacks.
15791
15792 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15793 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015794 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015795 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15796 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15797
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015798 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15799 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15800 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015801 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15802 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015804 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15805 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15806 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15807 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015808 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15809 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15810 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15811 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15812 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015813
15814 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15815 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15816 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15817 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15818
15819 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15820 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15821 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15822 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15823
15824 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15825 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15826 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15827 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15828
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015829The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15830persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15831important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15832re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15833
15834 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15835
15836 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15837 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15838 set on a GET request.
15839
15840 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15841 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015842 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015843 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15844
15845 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15846 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15847 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15848
15849 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15850 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15851 already got a cookie.
15852
15853 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15854 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15855 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15856 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15857 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15858
15859 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15860 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15861 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15862
15863 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15864 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15865 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15866
15867 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15868 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15869
15870 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15871 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15872 then advertised in the response.
15873
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158758.6. Non-printable characters
15876-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015877
15878In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15879consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15880converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15881prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15882being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15883escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15884is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15885'}' when logging headers.
15886
15887Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15888issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15889containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15890
15891Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15892the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15893performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15894
15895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15897---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015898
15899Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15900achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015901section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015902cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15903the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15904the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015905locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015906not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15907user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15908a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15909wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15910
15911 Examples :
15912 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15913 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15914
15915 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15916 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15917
15918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159198.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15920---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015921
15922Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15923proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15924the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15925server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15926
15927Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15928response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015929section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015930
15931It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015932time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15933appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015934are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15935and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15936follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15937request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15938in the logs.
15939
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015940As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15941frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15942an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15943
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015944 Example :
15945 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15946 listen proxy-out
15947 mode http
15948 option httplog
15949 option logasap
15950 log global
15951 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15952
15953 # log the name of the virtual server
15954 capture request header Host len 20
15955
15956 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15957 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15958
15959 # log the beginning of the referrer
15960 capture request header Referer len 20
15961
15962 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15963 capture response header Server len 20
15964
15965 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15966 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15967
15968 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15969 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15970
15971 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15972 capture response header Via len 20
15973
15974 # log the URL location during a redirection
15975 capture response header Location len 20
15976
15977 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15978 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15979 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15980 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15981 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15982
15983 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15984 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15985 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15986 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015987 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015988
15989 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15990 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15991 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15992 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15993 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015994 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015995
15996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159978.9. Examples of logs
15998---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015999
16000These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16001them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16002reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16003
16004 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16005 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16006 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16007
16008 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16009 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16010
16011 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16012 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16013 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16014
16015 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16016 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16017
16018 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16019 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16020 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16021
16022 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016023 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016024 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16025 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16026
16027 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16028 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16029 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16030
16031 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16032 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016033 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016034 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16035 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16036 to return the 502 and not the server.
16037
16038 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016039 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016040
16041 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16042 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16043 Nothing was sent to any server.
16044
16045 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16046 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16047
16048 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16049 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16050 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16051 send a 408 return code to the client.
16052
16053 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16054 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16055
16056 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16057 5 seconds ("c----").
16058
16059 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16060 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016061 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016062
16063 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016064 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016065 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16066 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16067 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16068 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16069 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016070
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016071
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200160729. Supported filters
16073--------------------
16074
16075Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16076accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16077unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16078
16079See also : "filter"
16080
160819.1. Trace
16082----------
16083
16084filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
16085
16086 Arguments:
16087 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16088 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16089
16090 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16091 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16092 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16093 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16094
16095 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16096 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16097 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16098 amount of the parsed data.
16099
16100This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16101callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16102information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16103filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16104
16105Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16106tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16107a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16108
16109
161109.2. HTTP compression
16111---------------------
16112
16113filter compression
16114
16115The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16116keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16117when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16118use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16119used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16120filters evaluation order.
16121
16122See also : "compression"
16123
16124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016125/*
16126 * Local variables:
16127 * fill-column: 79
16128 * End:
16129 */